1 1.1 christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF 2 1.12 christos Copyright (C) 1994-2025 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 3 1.1 christos Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support. 4 1.1 christos 5 1.1 christos This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library. 6 1.1 christos 7 1.1 christos This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify 8 1.1 christos it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by 9 1.1 christos the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or 10 1.1 christos (at your option) any later version. 11 1.1 christos 12 1.1 christos This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, 13 1.1 christos but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of 14 1.1 christos MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the 15 1.1 christos GNU General Public License for more details. 16 1.1 christos 17 1.1 christos You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License 18 1.1 christos along with this program; if not, write to the 19 1.1 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, 20 1.1 christos Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */ 21 1.1 christos 22 1.10 christos /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even 23 1.10 christos when they appear unused. The linux kernel build tool recordmcount 24 1.10 christos needs them. */ 25 1.10 christos #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true 26 1.1 christos 27 1.1 christos #include "sysdep.h" 28 1.1 christos #include <stdarg.h> 29 1.1 christos #include "bfd.h" 30 1.1 christos #include "bfdlink.h" 31 1.1 christos #include "libbfd.h" 32 1.1 christos #include "elf-bfd.h" 33 1.1 christos #include "elf/ppc.h" 34 1.1 christos #include "elf32-ppc.h" 35 1.1 christos #include "elf-vxworks.h" 36 1.1 christos #include "dwarf2.h" 37 1.7 christos #include "opcode/ppc.h" 38 1.1 christos 39 1.9 christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */ 40 1.9 christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1 41 1.9 christos 42 1.1 christos typedef enum split16_format_type 43 1.1 christos { 44 1.1 christos split16a_type = 0, 45 1.1 christos split16d_type 46 1.1 christos } 47 1.1 christos split16_format_type; 48 1.1 christos 49 1.1 christos /* RELA relocations are used here. */ 50 1.1 christos 51 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc 52 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **); 53 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc 54 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **); 55 1.1 christos 56 1.1 christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */ 57 1.1 christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000 58 1.1 christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */ 59 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000 60 1.1 christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */ 61 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16 62 1.1 christos 63 1.1 christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp 64 1.1 christos section. */ 65 1.1 christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1" 66 1.1 christos 67 1.1 christos /* For old-style PLT. */ 68 1.1 christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */ 69 1.1 christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192 70 1.1 christos 71 1.1 christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */ 72 1.1 christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4 73 1.7 christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \ 74 1.7 christos ((4*4 \ 75 1.7 christos + (h != NULL \ 76 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr \ 77 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \ 78 1.7 christos + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \ 79 1.7 christos & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align)) 80 1.1 christos 81 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */ 82 1.1 christos 83 1.1 christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */ 84 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32 85 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry 86 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] = 87 1.1 christos { 88 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */ 89 1.7 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */ 90 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */ 91 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 92 1.7 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */ 93 1.7 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */ 94 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 95 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 96 1.1 christos }; 97 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry 98 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] = 99 1.1 christos { 100 1.1 christos 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */ 101 1.1 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */ 102 1.1 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */ 103 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 104 1.1 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */ 105 1.1 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */ 106 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 107 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 108 1.1 christos }; 109 1.1 christos 110 1.1 christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */ 111 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32 112 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry 113 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] = 114 1.1 christos { 115 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */ 116 1.7 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */ 117 1.7 christos 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */ 118 1.7 christos 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */ 119 1.7 christos 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */ 120 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 121 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 122 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 123 1.1 christos }; 124 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry 125 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] = 126 1.1 christos { 127 1.1 christos 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */ 128 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */ 129 1.1 christos 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */ 130 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 131 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 132 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 133 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 134 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */ 135 1.1 christos }; 136 1.1 christos 137 1.1 christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in 138 1.1 christos .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */ 139 1.1 christos 140 1.1 christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */ 141 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3 142 1.1 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */ 143 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2 144 1.7 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating 145 1.1 christos a shared library. */ 146 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0 147 1.1 christos 148 1.1 christos /* Some instructions. */ 149 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000 150 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000 151 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000 152 1.1 christos #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000 153 1.1 christos #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14 154 1.1 christos #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214 155 1.1 christos #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14 156 1.1 christos #define B 0x48000000 157 1.3 christos #define BA 0x48000002 158 1.1 christos #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005 159 1.1 christos #define BCTR 0x4e800420 160 1.1 christos #define BEQLR 0x4d820020 161 1.1 christos #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000 162 1.1 christos #define LIS_11 0x3d600000 163 1.1 christos #define LIS_12 0x3d800000 164 1.1 christos #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000 165 1.1 christos #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000 166 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000 167 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000 168 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000 169 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000 170 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000 171 1.1 christos #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78 172 1.1 christos #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378 173 1.1 christos #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6 174 1.1 christos #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6 175 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6 176 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6 177 1.1 christos #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6 178 1.1 christos #define NOP 0x60000000 179 1.1 christos #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850 180 1.1 christos 181 1.1 christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */ 182 1.1 christos #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000 183 1.1 christos #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000 184 1.1 christos 185 1.1 christos /* The value of a defined global symbol. */ 186 1.1 christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \ 187 1.1 christos ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \ 188 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \ 189 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.value) 190 1.1 christos 191 1.9 christos /* Relocation HOWTO's. */ 193 1.9 christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple 194 1.9 christos field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is 195 1.9 christos always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative. 196 1.9 christos PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at 197 1.9 christos the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24 198 1.9 christos and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here, 199 1.9 christos rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */ 200 1.9 christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \ 201 1.9 christos complain, special_func) \ 202 1.9 christos HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \ 203 1.10 christos complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \ 204 1.9 christos #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative) 205 1.1 christos 206 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max]; 207 1.1 christos 208 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = { 209 1.10 christos /* This reloc does nothing. */ 210 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont, 211 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 212 1.1 christos 213 1.10 christos /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */ 214 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 215 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 216 1.1 christos 217 1.1 christos /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. 218 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */ 219 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed, 220 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 221 1.1 christos 222 1.10 christos /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */ 223 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield, 224 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 225 1.1 christos 226 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */ 227 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 228 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 229 1.1 christos 230 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */ 231 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 232 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 233 1.1 christos 234 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of 235 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */ 236 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 237 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc), 238 1.1 christos 239 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. 240 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */ 241 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed, 242 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 243 1.1 christos 244 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to 245 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two 246 1.10 christos bits must be zero. */ 247 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed, 248 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 249 1.1 christos 250 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to 251 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower 252 1.10 christos two bits must be zero. */ 253 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed, 254 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 255 1.1 christos 256 1.10 christos /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */ 257 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed, 258 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 259 1.1 christos 260 1.10 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */ 261 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed, 262 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 263 1.1 christos 264 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that 265 1.1 christos the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be 266 1.10 christos zero. */ 267 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed, 268 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 269 1.1 christos 270 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that 271 1.1 christos the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must 272 1.10 christos be zero. */ 273 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed, 274 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 275 1.1 christos 276 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the 277 1.10 christos symbol. */ 278 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 279 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 280 1.1 christos 281 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for 282 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 283 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 284 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 285 1.1 christos 286 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for 287 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 288 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 289 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 290 1.1 christos 291 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for 292 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 293 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 294 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 295 1.1 christos 296 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table 297 1.10 christos entry for the symbol. */ 298 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed, 299 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 300 1.1 christos 301 1.1 christos /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist 302 1.1 christos both in the object being run and in some shared library. The 303 1.1 christos dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the 304 1.1 christos shared library into the object, because the object being 305 1.10 christos run has to have the data at some particular address. */ 306 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 307 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 308 1.1 christos 309 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table 310 1.10 christos entries. */ 311 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 312 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 313 1.1 christos 314 1.10 christos /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */ 315 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 316 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 317 1.1 christos 318 1.1 christos /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this 319 1.1 christos longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the 320 1.10 christos addend. */ 321 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 322 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 323 1.1 christos 324 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the 325 1.1 christos object rather than the final value. Normally used for 326 1.10 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */ 327 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed, 328 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 329 1.1 christos 330 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */ 331 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 332 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 333 1.1 christos 334 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */ 335 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield, 336 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 337 1.1 christos 338 1.10 christos /* 32-bit PC relative */ 339 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont, 340 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 341 1.1 christos 342 1.1 christos /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. 343 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */ 344 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 345 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 346 1.1 christos 347 1.1 christos /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. 348 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */ 349 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont, 350 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 351 1.1 christos 352 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for 353 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 354 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 355 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 356 1.1 christos 357 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for 358 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 359 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 360 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 361 1.1 christos 362 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for 363 1.10 christos the symbol. */ 364 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 365 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 366 1.1 christos 367 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with 368 1.10 christos small data items. */ 369 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 370 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 371 1.1 christos 372 1.10 christos /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */ 373 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 374 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 375 1.1 christos 376 1.10 christos /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */ 377 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 378 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 379 1.1 christos 380 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */ 381 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 382 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 383 1.1 christos 384 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */ 385 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 386 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 387 1.1 christos 388 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs for TLS. */ 389 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 390 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 391 1.10 christos 392 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 393 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 394 1.10 christos 395 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 396 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 397 1.7 christos 398 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */ 399 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 400 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 401 1.10 christos 402 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont, 403 1.7 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 404 1.1 christos 405 1.1 christos /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the 406 1.10 christos definition of its TLS sym. */ 407 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 408 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 409 1.1 christos 410 1.1 christos /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value 411 1.1 christos of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that 412 1.10 christos contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */ 413 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 414 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 415 1.1 christos 416 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */ 417 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 418 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 419 1.1 christos 420 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */ 421 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 422 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 423 1.1 christos 424 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 425 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 426 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 427 1.1 christos 428 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 429 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 430 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 431 1.1 christos 432 1.1 christos /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of 433 1.10 christos sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */ 434 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 435 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 436 1.1 christos 437 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */ 438 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 439 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 440 1.1 christos 441 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */ 442 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 443 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 444 1.1 christos 445 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 446 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 447 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 448 1.1 christos 449 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 450 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 451 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 452 1.1 christos 453 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure, 454 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset 455 1.10 christos to the first entry. */ 456 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 457 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 458 1.1 christos 459 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */ 460 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 461 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 462 1.1 christos 463 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 464 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 465 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 466 1.1 christos 467 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 468 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 469 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 470 1.1 christos 471 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure, 472 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the 473 1.10 christos first entry. */ 474 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 475 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 476 1.1 christos 477 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */ 478 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 479 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 480 1.1 christos 481 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 482 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 483 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 484 1.1 christos 485 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 486 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 487 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 488 1.1 christos 489 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes 490 1.10 christos the offset to the entry. */ 491 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 492 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 493 1.1 christos 494 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */ 495 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 496 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 497 1.1 christos 498 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 499 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 500 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 501 1.1 christos 502 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 503 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 504 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 505 1.1 christos 506 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the 507 1.10 christos offset to the entry. */ 508 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 509 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 510 1.1 christos 511 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */ 512 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 513 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 514 1.1 christos 515 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */ 516 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 517 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 518 1.1 christos 519 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */ 520 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 521 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 522 1.1 christos 523 1.1 christos /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not 524 1.1 christos in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */ 525 1.1 christos 526 1.10 christos /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */ 527 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 528 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 529 1.1 christos 530 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */ 531 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 532 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 533 1.1 christos 534 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */ 535 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 536 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 537 1.1 christos 538 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */ 539 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 540 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 541 1.1 christos 542 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address, 543 1.1 christos plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, 544 1.10 christos is negative. */ 545 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont, 546 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 547 1.1 christos 548 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an 549 1.1 christos address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from 550 1.10 christos _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */ 551 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 552 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 553 1.1 christos 554 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an 555 1.1 christos address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from 556 1.10 christos _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */ 557 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 558 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 559 1.1 christos 560 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with 561 1.10 christos small data items. */ 562 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 563 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 564 1.1 christos 565 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit 566 1.1 christos signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register 567 1.10 christos field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */ 568 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 569 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 570 1.1 christos 571 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */ 572 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */ 573 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */ 574 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */ 575 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */ 576 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */ 577 1.1 christos 578 1.1 christos /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling 579 1.1 christos in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the 580 1.10 christos register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */ 581 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 582 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 583 1.1 christos 584 1.10 christos /* A relative 8 bit branch. */ 585 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed, 586 1.3 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 587 1.1 christos 588 1.10 christos /* A relative 15 bit branch. */ 589 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed, 590 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 591 1.3 christos 592 1.10 christos /* A relative 24 bit branch. */ 593 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed, 594 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 595 1.1 christos 596 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */ 597 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont, 598 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 599 1.1 christos 600 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */ 601 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont, 602 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 603 1.1 christos 604 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */ 605 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont, 606 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 607 1.1 christos 608 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */ 609 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont, 610 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 611 1.1 christos 612 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */ 613 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont, 614 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 615 1.1 christos 616 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */ 617 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont, 618 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 619 1.3 christos 620 1.3 christos /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i 621 1.3 christos instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes 622 1.10 christos the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */ 623 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 624 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 625 1.3 christos 626 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */ 627 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont, 628 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 629 1.1 christos 630 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */ 631 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont, 632 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 633 1.1 christos 634 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */ 635 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont, 636 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 637 1.1 christos 638 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */ 639 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont, 640 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 641 1.1 christos 642 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */ 643 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont, 644 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 645 1.1 christos 646 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */ 647 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont, 648 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 649 1.1 christos 650 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */ 651 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont, 652 1.7 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 653 1.7 christos 654 1.10 christos /* e_li split20 format. */ 655 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont, 656 1.9 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 657 1.10 christos 658 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont, 659 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 660 1.1 christos 661 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */ 662 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed, 663 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 664 1.1 christos 665 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */ 666 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont, 667 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 668 1.1 christos 669 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */ 670 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont, 671 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc), 672 1.1 christos 673 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of 674 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */ 675 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont, 676 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc), 677 1.3 christos 678 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */ 679 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed, 680 1.3 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc), 681 1.7 christos 682 1.10 christos /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */ 683 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed, 684 1.7 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc), 685 1.1 christos 686 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */ 687 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont, 688 1.1 christos NULL), 689 1.1 christos 690 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */ 691 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont, 692 1.1 christos NULL), 693 1.1 christos 694 1.10 christos /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */ 695 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed, 696 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc), 697 1.1 christos }; 698 1.1 christos 699 1.1 christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */ 701 1.1 christos 702 1.1 christos static void 703 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void) 704 1.1 christos { 705 1.1 christos unsigned int i, type; 706 1.1 christos 707 1.1 christos for (i = 0; 708 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]); 709 1.1 christos i++) 710 1.1 christos { 711 1.1 christos type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type; 712 1.1 christos if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table) 713 1.1 christos / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0]))) 714 1.1 christos abort (); 715 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i]; 716 1.1 christos } 717 1.1 christos } 718 1.1 christos 719 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type * 720 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 721 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_code_real_type code) 722 1.1 christos { 723 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r; 724 1.1 christos 725 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */ 726 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32]) 727 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (); 728 1.1 christos 729 1.1 christos switch (code) 730 1.1 christos { 731 1.1 christos default: 732 1.1 christos return NULL; 733 1.1 christos 734 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break; 735 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break; 736 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break; 737 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS: 738 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break; 739 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS: 740 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break; 741 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break; 742 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break; 743 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break; 744 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break; 745 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break; 746 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break; 747 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break; 748 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break; 749 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break; 750 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS: 751 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break; 752 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS: 753 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break; 754 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break; 755 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break; 756 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break; 757 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break; 758 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break; 759 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break; 760 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break; 761 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break; 762 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break; 763 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS: 764 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break; 765 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break; 766 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break; 767 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break; 768 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS: 769 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break; 770 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS: 771 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break; 772 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break; 773 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break; 774 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break; 775 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS: 776 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break; 777 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break; 778 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break; 779 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break; 780 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break; 781 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS: 782 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break; 783 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS: 784 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break; 785 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break; 786 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break; 787 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break; 788 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS: 789 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break; 790 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS: 791 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break; 792 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break; 793 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break; 794 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break; 795 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break; 796 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break; 797 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break; 798 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break; 799 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break; 800 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break; 801 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break; 802 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break; 803 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break; 804 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break; 805 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break; 806 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break; 807 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break; 808 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break; 809 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break; 810 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break; 811 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break; 812 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break; 813 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break; 814 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break; 815 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break; 816 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break; 817 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break; 818 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break; 819 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break; 820 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break; 821 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break; 822 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break; 823 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break; 824 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break; 825 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break; 826 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break; 827 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break; 828 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break; 829 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break; 830 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break; 831 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break; 832 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break; 833 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break; 834 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break; 835 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break; 836 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break; 837 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break; 838 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A: 839 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A; 840 1.1 christos break; 841 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D: 842 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D; 843 1.1 christos break; 844 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A: 845 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A; 846 1.1 christos break; 847 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D: 848 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D; 849 1.1 christos break; 850 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A: 851 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A; 852 1.1 christos break; 853 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D: 854 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D; 855 1.1 christos break; 856 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break; 857 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break; 858 1.7 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break; 859 1.3 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break; 860 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break; 861 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break; 862 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break; 863 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break; 864 1.1 christos } 865 1.1 christos 866 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_howto_table[r]; 867 1.1 christos }; 868 1.1 christos 869 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type * 870 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 871 1.1 christos const char *r_name) 872 1.1 christos { 873 1.1 christos unsigned int i; 874 1.1 christos 875 1.1 christos for (i = 0; 876 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]); 877 1.1 christos i++) 878 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL 879 1.1 christos && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0) 880 1.1 christos return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i]; 881 1.1 christos 882 1.1 christos return NULL; 883 1.1 christos } 884 1.1 christos 885 1.10 christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */ 886 1.7 christos 887 1.1 christos static bool 888 1.1 christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, 889 1.1 christos arelent *cache_ptr, 890 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *dst) 891 1.3 christos { 892 1.1 christos unsigned int r_type; 893 1.1 christos 894 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */ 895 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32]) 896 1.3 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (); 897 1.3 christos 898 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info); 899 1.7 christos if (r_type >= R_PPC_max) 900 1.7 christos { 901 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 902 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), 903 1.10 christos abfd, r_type); 904 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 905 1.7 christos return false; 906 1.3 christos } 907 1.1 christos 908 1.1 christos cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]; 909 1.1 christos 910 1.7 christos /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that 911 1.1 christos ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */ 912 1.7 christos if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL) 913 1.7 christos { 914 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 915 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), 916 1.1 christos abfd, r_type); 917 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 918 1.1 christos 919 1.7 christos return false; 920 1.10 christos } 921 1.1 christos 922 1.1 christos return true; 923 1.1 christos } 924 1.1 christos 925 1.1 christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */ 926 1.7 christos 927 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type 928 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, 929 1.7 christos arelent *reloc_entry, 930 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol, 931 1.1 christos void *data, 932 1.1 christos asection *input_section, 933 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd, 934 1.3 christos char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 935 1.3 christos { 936 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 937 1.3 christos long insn; 938 1.1 christos bfd_size_type octets; 939 1.1 christos bfd_vma value; 940 1.1 christos 941 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL) 942 1.1 christos { 943 1.1 christos reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset; 944 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok; 945 1.3 christos } 946 1.3 christos 947 1.3 christos reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000; 948 1.3 christos r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type; 949 1.3 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA) 950 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_continue; 951 1.3 christos 952 1.3 christos value = 0; 953 1.3 christos if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section)) 954 1.3 christos value = symbol->value; 955 1.3 christos value += (reloc_entry->addend 956 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_offset 957 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_section->vma); 958 1.3 christos value -= (reloc_entry->address 959 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset 960 1.3 christos + input_section->output_section->vma); 961 1.9 christos value >>= 16; 962 1.10 christos 963 1.10 christos octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section); 964 1.10 christos if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, 965 1.10 christos input_section, octets)) 966 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 967 1.3 christos 968 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets); 969 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1; 970 1.3 christos insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15); 971 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets); 972 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok; 973 1.1 christos } 974 1.1 christos 975 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type 976 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, 977 1.1 christos arelent *reloc_entry, 978 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol, 979 1.1 christos void *data, 980 1.1 christos asection *input_section, 981 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd, 982 1.1 christos char **error_message) 983 1.1 christos { 984 1.1 christos /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just 985 1.1 christos call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final 986 1.1 christos link time. */ 987 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL) 988 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data, 989 1.1 christos input_section, output_bfd, error_message); 990 1.11 christos 991 1.11 christos if (error_message != NULL) 992 1.1 christos *error_message = bfd_asprintf (_("generic linker can't handle %s"), 993 1.1 christos reloc_entry->howto->name); 994 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_dangerous; 995 1.1 christos } 996 1.1 christos 997 1.1 christos /* Sections created by the linker. */ 999 1.1 christos 1000 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section 1001 1.1 christos { 1002 1.1 christos /* Pointer to the bfd section. */ 1003 1.1 christos asection *section; 1004 1.1 christos /* Section name. */ 1005 1.1 christos const char *name; 1006 1.1 christos /* Associated bss section name. */ 1007 1.1 christos const char *bss_name; 1008 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol name. */ 1009 1.1 christos const char *sym_name; 1010 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol. */ 1011 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym; 1012 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_t; 1013 1.1 christos 1014 1.1 christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the 1015 1.1 christos symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers, 1016 1.1 christos based on different addend's. */ 1017 1.1 christos 1018 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers 1019 1.1 christos { 1020 1.1 christos /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */ 1021 1.1 christos struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next; 1022 1.1 christos /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */ 1023 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset; 1024 1.1 christos /* addend used */ 1025 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend; 1026 1.1 christos /* which linker section this is */ 1027 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect; 1028 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t; 1029 1.1 christos 1030 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata 1031 1.1 christos { 1032 1.1 christos struct elf_obj_tdata elf; 1033 1.1 christos 1034 1.1 christos /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker 1035 1.1 christos sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */ 1036 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers; 1037 1.1 christos 1038 1.1 christos /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */ 1039 1.1 christos unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1; 1040 1.1 christos unsigned int has_rel16 : 1; 1041 1.1 christos }; 1042 1.1 christos 1043 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \ 1044 1.1 christos ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any) 1045 1.1 christos 1046 1.1 christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \ 1047 1.1 christos (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers) 1048 1.1 christos 1049 1.1 christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \ 1050 1.1 christos (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \ 1051 1.1 christos && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) 1052 1.10 christos 1053 1.1 christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */ 1054 1.1 christos 1055 1.12 christos static bool 1056 1.1 christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd) 1057 1.1 christos { 1058 1.6 christos return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata)); 1059 1.6 christos } 1060 1.10 christos 1061 1.6 christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */ 1062 1.6 christos 1063 1.6 christos bool 1064 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd) 1065 1.6 christos { 1066 1.6 christos unsigned long mach = 0; 1067 1.6 christos asection *s; 1068 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents; 1069 1.6 christos 1070 1.6 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32 1071 1.6 christos && bfd_big_endian (abfd)) 1072 1.6 christos { 1073 1.6 christos 1074 1.6 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 1075 1.6 christos if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0) 1076 1.6 christos break; 1077 1.6 christos if (s != NULL) 1078 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle; 1079 1.6 christos } 1080 1.6 christos 1081 1.9 christos if (mach == 0) 1082 1.9 christos { 1083 1.11 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME); 1084 1.9 christos if (s != NULL 1085 1.6 christos && s->size >= 24 1086 1.6 christos && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 1087 1.6 christos && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents)) 1088 1.6 christos { 1089 1.6 christos unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4); 1090 1.6 christos unsigned int i; 1091 1.6 christos 1092 1.6 christos for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4) 1093 1.6 christos { 1094 1.6 christos unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i); 1095 1.6 christos switch (val >> 16) 1096 1.6 christos { 1097 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_PMR: 1098 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI: 1099 1.6 christos if (mach == 0) 1100 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan; 1101 1.6 christos break; 1102 1.6 christos 1103 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL: 1104 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK: 1105 1.6 christos if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan) 1106 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc; 1107 1.6 christos break; 1108 1.6 christos 1109 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_SPE: 1110 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_EFS: 1111 1.7 christos case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK: 1112 1.6 christos if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle) 1113 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500; 1114 1.6 christos break; 1115 1.6 christos 1116 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_VLE: 1117 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle; 1118 1.6 christos break; 1119 1.6 christos 1120 1.6 christos default: 1121 1.6 christos mach = -1ul; 1122 1.6 christos } 1123 1.6 christos } 1124 1.6 christos free (contents); 1125 1.6 christos } 1126 1.6 christos } 1127 1.6 christos 1128 1.6 christos if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul) 1129 1.6 christos { 1130 1.6 christos const bfd_arch_info_type *arch; 1131 1.6 christos 1132 1.6 christos for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next) 1133 1.6 christos if (arch->mach == mach) 1134 1.6 christos { 1135 1.6 christos abfd->arch_info = arch; 1136 1.10 christos break; 1137 1.6 christos } 1138 1.6 christos } 1139 1.1 christos return true; 1140 1.6 christos } 1141 1.1 christos 1142 1.10 christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the 1143 1.1 christos default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */ 1144 1.1 christos 1145 1.6 christos static bool 1146 1.10 christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd) 1147 1.6 christos { 1148 1.6 christos if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default) 1149 1.1 christos return true; 1150 1.1 christos 1151 1.1 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64) 1152 1.1 christos { 1153 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd); 1154 1.1 christos 1155 1.1 christos if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32) 1156 1.1 christos { 1157 1.1 christos /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */ 1158 1.1 christos abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next; 1159 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32); 1160 1.1 christos } 1161 1.1 christos } 1162 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd); 1163 1.1 christos } 1164 1.10 christos 1165 1.1 christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */ 1166 1.1 christos 1167 1.1 christos static bool 1168 1.1 christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags) 1169 1.1 christos { 1170 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd) 1171 1.10 christos || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags); 1172 1.10 christos 1173 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags; 1174 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (abfd) = true; 1175 1.1 christos return true; 1176 1.1 christos } 1177 1.10 christos 1178 1.1 christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */ 1179 1.1 christos 1180 1.1 christos static bool 1181 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note) 1182 1.1 christos { 1183 1.1 christos int offset; 1184 1.1 christos unsigned int size; 1185 1.1 christos 1186 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz) 1187 1.1 christos { 1188 1.1 christos default: 1189 1.1 christos return false; 1190 1.3 christos 1191 1.1 christos case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */ 1192 1.1 christos /* pr_cursig */ 1193 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12); 1194 1.1 christos 1195 1.1 christos /* pr_pid */ 1196 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24); 1197 1.1 christos 1198 1.1 christos /* pr_reg */ 1199 1.1 christos offset = 72; 1200 1.1 christos size = 192; 1201 1.1 christos 1202 1.1 christos break; 1203 1.1 christos } 1204 1.1 christos 1205 1.1 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */ 1206 1.1 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", 1207 1.10 christos size, note->descpos + offset); 1208 1.1 christos } 1209 1.1 christos 1210 1.1 christos static bool 1211 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note) 1212 1.1 christos { 1213 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz) 1214 1.1 christos { 1215 1.1 christos default: 1216 1.3 christos return false; 1217 1.1 christos 1218 1.3 christos case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */ 1219 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid 1220 1.3 christos = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16); 1221 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program 1222 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16); 1223 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command 1224 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80); 1225 1.1 christos } 1226 1.1 christos 1227 1.1 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked 1228 1.1 christos onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway) 1229 1.3 christos implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */ 1230 1.1 christos 1231 1.1 christos { 1232 1.1 christos char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command; 1233 1.1 christos int n = strlen (command); 1234 1.1 christos 1235 1.1 christos if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ') 1236 1.10 christos command[n - 1] = '\0'; 1237 1.1 christos } 1238 1.1 christos 1239 1.1 christos return true; 1240 1.1 christos } 1241 1.1 christos 1242 1.1 christos static char * 1243 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...) 1244 1.1 christos { 1245 1.1 christos switch (note_type) 1246 1.1 christos { 1247 1.1 christos default: 1248 1.1 christos return NULL; 1249 1.7 christos 1250 1.1 christos case NT_PRPSINFO: 1251 1.1 christos { 1252 1.1 christos char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING; 1253 1.1 christos va_list ap; 1254 1.1 christos 1255 1.9 christos va_start (ap, note_type); 1256 1.7 christos memset (data, 0, sizeof (data)); 1257 1.9 christos strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16); 1258 1.7 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001 1259 1.7 christos DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH; 1260 1.7 christos /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with 1261 1.7 christos -Wstringop-truncation: 1262 1.7 christos https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643 1263 1.1 christos */ 1264 1.9 christos DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION; 1265 1.7 christos #endif 1266 1.7 christos strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80); 1267 1.1 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001 1268 1.1 christos DIAGNOSTIC_POP; 1269 1.1 christos #endif 1270 1.1 christos va_end (ap); 1271 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, 1272 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data)); 1273 1.1 christos } 1274 1.1 christos 1275 1.1 christos case NT_PRSTATUS: 1276 1.1 christos { 1277 1.1 christos char data[268]; 1278 1.1 christos va_list ap; 1279 1.1 christos long pid; 1280 1.1 christos int cursig; 1281 1.1 christos const void *greg; 1282 1.1 christos 1283 1.1 christos va_start (ap, note_type); 1284 1.1 christos memset (data, 0, 72); 1285 1.1 christos pid = va_arg (ap, long); 1286 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24); 1287 1.1 christos cursig = va_arg (ap, int); 1288 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12); 1289 1.1 christos greg = va_arg (ap, const void *); 1290 1.1 christos memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192); 1291 1.1 christos memset (data + 264, 0, 4); 1292 1.1 christos va_end (ap); 1293 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, 1294 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data)); 1295 1.1 christos } 1296 1.1 christos } 1297 1.3 christos } 1298 1.1 christos 1299 1.1 christos static flagword 1300 1.1 christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name) 1301 1.1 christos { 1302 1.1 christos 1303 1.1 christos if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE")) 1304 1.1 christos return SHF_PPC_VLE; 1305 1.1 christos 1306 1.1 christos return 0; 1307 1.1 christos } 1308 1.1 christos 1309 1.1 christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL 1310 1.1 christos or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */ 1311 1.1 christos 1312 1.1 christos static bfd_vma 1313 1.1 christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1314 1.1 christos const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1315 1.1 christos const arelent *rel) 1316 1.1 christos { 1317 1.1 christos return rel->address; 1318 1.1 christos } 1319 1.1 christos 1320 1.1 christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This 1321 1.10 christos is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown 1322 1.1 christos type. */ 1323 1.1 christos 1324 1.1 christos static bool 1325 1.1 christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, 1326 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, 1327 1.1 christos const char *name, 1328 1.1 christos int shindex) 1329 1.1 christos { 1330 1.1 christos asection *newsect; 1331 1.10 christos flagword flags; 1332 1.1 christos 1333 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex)) 1334 1.10 christos return false; 1335 1.1 christos 1336 1.1 christos newsect = hdr->bfd_section; 1337 1.1 christos flags = 0; 1338 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) 1339 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 1340 1.1 christos 1341 1.10 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED) 1342 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES; 1343 1.10 christos 1344 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB")) 1345 1.10 christos name += 8; 1346 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".sbss") 1347 1.10 christos || startswith (name, ".sdata")) 1348 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA; 1349 1.1 christos 1350 1.1 christos return (flags == 0 1351 1.1 christos || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags)); 1352 1.1 christos } 1353 1.10 christos 1354 1.1 christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */ 1355 1.1 christos 1356 1.1 christos static bool 1357 1.1 christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1358 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr, 1359 1.1 christos asection *asect) 1360 1.1 christos { 1361 1.10 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0) 1362 1.1 christos shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED; 1363 1.1 christos 1364 1.1 christos return true; 1365 1.1 christos } 1366 1.1 christos 1367 1.1 christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we 1368 1.1 christos need to bump up the number of section headers. */ 1369 1.1 christos 1370 1.1 christos static int 1371 1.1 christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd, 1372 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1373 1.1 christos { 1374 1.1 christos asection *s; 1375 1.1 christos int ret = 0; 1376 1.1 christos 1377 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2"); 1378 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 1379 1.1 christos ++ret; 1380 1.1 christos 1381 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0"); 1382 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 1383 1.1 christos ++ret; 1384 1.1 christos 1385 1.3 christos return ret; 1386 1.1 christos } 1387 1.10 christos 1388 1.1 christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */ 1389 1.1 christos 1390 1.1 christos bool 1391 1.7 christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd, 1392 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1393 1.1 christos { 1394 1.1 christos struct elf_segment_map *m; 1395 1.1 christos 1396 1.1 christos /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by 1397 1.1 christos LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure 1398 1.1 christos there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment. 1399 1.3 christos If we find that case, we split the segment. 1400 1.1 christos We maintain the original output section order. */ 1401 1.7 christos 1402 1.10 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next) 1403 1.7 christos { 1404 1.7 christos struct elf_segment_map *n; 1405 1.7 christos size_t amt; 1406 1.7 christos unsigned int j, k; 1407 1.1 christos unsigned int p_flags; 1408 1.1 christos 1409 1.7 christos if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0) 1410 1.1 christos continue; 1411 1.7 christos 1412 1.7 christos for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j) 1413 1.7 christos { 1414 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0) 1415 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_W; 1416 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0) 1417 1.7 christos { 1418 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_X; 1419 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0) 1420 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE; 1421 1.7 christos break; 1422 1.7 christos } 1423 1.7 christos } 1424 1.7 christos if (j != m->count) 1425 1.1 christos while (++j != m->count) 1426 1.7 christos { 1427 1.7 christos unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R; 1428 1.7 christos 1429 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0) 1430 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_W; 1431 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0) 1432 1.7 christos { 1433 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_X; 1434 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0) 1435 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE; 1436 1.7 christos if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0) 1437 1.7 christos break; 1438 1.7 christos } 1439 1.7 christos p_flags |= p_flags1; 1440 1.7 christos } 1441 1.7 christos /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw 1442 1.7 christos sections then those sections might now only be in one of the 1443 1.7 christos two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we 1444 1.7 christos are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */ 1445 1.7 christos if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid) 1446 1.7 christos { 1447 1.7 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1; 1448 1.1 christos m->p_flags = p_flags; 1449 1.1 christos } 1450 1.7 christos if (j == m->count) 1451 1.1 christos continue; 1452 1.1 christos 1453 1.1 christos /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment, 1454 1.1 christos the remainder are put in a new segment. 1455 1.1 christos The scan resumes with the new segment. */ 1456 1.1 christos 1457 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map); 1458 1.10 christos amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *); 1459 1.1 christos n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 1460 1.1 christos if (n == NULL) 1461 1.1 christos return false; 1462 1.1 christos 1463 1.7 christos n->p_type = PT_LOAD; 1464 1.7 christos n->count = m->count - j; 1465 1.7 christos for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k) 1466 1.1 christos n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k]; 1467 1.1 christos m->count = j; 1468 1.1 christos m->p_size_valid = 0; 1469 1.1 christos n->next = m->next; 1470 1.10 christos m->next = n; 1471 1.1 christos } 1472 1.1 christos 1473 1.1 christos return true; 1474 1.1 christos } 1475 1.1 christos 1476 1.1 christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and 1477 1.1 christos .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so 1478 1.1 christos that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than 1479 1.1 christos 2 sections. */ 1480 1.6 christos 1481 1.6 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] = 1482 1.6 christos { 1483 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR }, 1484 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE }, 1485 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC }, 1486 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE }, 1487 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC }, 1488 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC }, 1489 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 }, 1490 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC }, 1491 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC }, 1492 1.1 christos { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 } 1493 1.10 christos }; 1494 1.7 christos 1495 1.1 christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */ 1496 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt = 1497 1.7 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC }; 1498 1.1 christos 1499 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * 1500 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec) 1501 1.1 christos { 1502 1.1 christos const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect; 1503 1.1 christos 1504 1.1 christos /* See if this is one of the special sections. */ 1505 1.1 christos if (sec->name == NULL) 1506 1.1 christos return NULL; 1507 1.1 christos 1508 1.1 christos ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections, 1509 1.1 christos sec->use_rela_p); 1510 1.1 christos if (ssect != NULL) 1511 1.1 christos { 1512 1.1 christos if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) 1513 1.1 christos ssect = &ppc_alt_plt; 1514 1.1 christos return ssect; 1515 1.1 christos } 1516 1.1 christos 1517 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec); 1518 1.1 christos } 1519 1.1 christos 1520 1.1 christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */ 1522 1.1 christos typedef struct apuinfo_list 1523 1.1 christos { 1524 1.1 christos struct apuinfo_list *next; 1525 1.1 christos unsigned long value; 1526 1.10 christos } 1527 1.1 christos apuinfo_list; 1528 1.1 christos 1529 1.1 christos static apuinfo_list *head; 1530 1.1 christos static bool apuinfo_set; 1531 1.1 christos 1532 1.10 christos static void 1533 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (void) 1534 1.1 christos { 1535 1.1 christos head = NULL; 1536 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = false; 1537 1.1 christos } 1538 1.1 christos 1539 1.1 christos static void 1540 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value) 1541 1.1 christos { 1542 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry = head; 1543 1.1 christos 1544 1.1 christos while (entry != NULL) 1545 1.1 christos { 1546 1.1 christos if (entry->value == value) 1547 1.1 christos return; 1548 1.1 christos entry = entry->next; 1549 1.1 christos } 1550 1.1 christos 1551 1.1 christos entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry)); 1552 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL) 1553 1.1 christos return; 1554 1.1 christos 1555 1.1 christos entry->value = value; 1556 1.1 christos entry->next = head; 1557 1.1 christos head = entry; 1558 1.1 christos } 1559 1.1 christos 1560 1.1 christos static unsigned 1561 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_length (void) 1562 1.1 christos { 1563 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry; 1564 1.1 christos unsigned long count; 1565 1.1 christos 1566 1.1 christos for (entry = head, count = 0; 1567 1.1 christos entry; 1568 1.1 christos entry = entry->next) 1569 1.1 christos ++ count; 1570 1.1 christos 1571 1.1 christos return count; 1572 1.1 christos } 1573 1.1 christos 1574 1.1 christos static inline unsigned long 1575 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number) 1576 1.1 christos { 1577 1.1 christos apuinfo_list * entry; 1578 1.1 christos 1579 1.1 christos for (entry = head; 1580 1.1 christos entry && number --; 1581 1.1 christos entry = entry->next) 1582 1.1 christos ; 1583 1.1 christos 1584 1.1 christos return entry ? entry->value : 0; 1585 1.1 christos } 1586 1.1 christos 1587 1.1 christos static void 1588 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish (void) 1589 1.1 christos { 1590 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry; 1591 1.1 christos 1592 1.1 christos for (entry = head; entry;) 1593 1.1 christos { 1594 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *next = entry->next; 1595 1.1 christos free (entry); 1596 1.1 christos entry = next; 1597 1.1 christos } 1598 1.1 christos 1599 1.1 christos head = NULL; 1600 1.1 christos } 1601 1.1 christos 1602 1.1 christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of 1603 1.1 christos the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */ 1604 1.1 christos 1605 1.1 christos static void 1606 1.1 christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info) 1607 1.1 christos { 1608 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd; 1609 1.1 christos asection *asec; 1610 1.1 christos char *buffer = NULL; 1611 1.1 christos bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0; 1612 1.1 christos unsigned i; 1613 1.1 christos unsigned long length; 1614 1.1 christos const char *error_message = NULL; 1615 1.1 christos 1616 1.1 christos if (link_info == NULL) 1617 1.1 christos return; 1618 1.3 christos 1619 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (); 1620 1.1 christos 1621 1.1 christos /* Read in the input sections contents. */ 1622 1.1 christos for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 1623 1.1 christos { 1624 1.1 christos unsigned long datum; 1625 1.1 christos 1626 1.7 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME); 1627 1.7 christos if (asec == NULL) 1628 1.1 christos continue; 1629 1.1 christos 1630 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 1631 1.1 christos error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB"); 1632 1.10 christos length = asec->size; 1633 1.1 christos if (length < 20) 1634 1.1 christos goto fail; 1635 1.10 christos 1636 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = true; 1637 1.1 christos if (largest_input_size < asec->size) 1638 1.1 christos { 1639 1.1 christos free (buffer); 1640 1.1 christos largest_input_size = asec->size; 1641 1.1 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size); 1642 1.1 christos if (!buffer) 1643 1.11 christos return; 1644 1.1 christos } 1645 1.7 christos 1646 1.7 christos if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0 1647 1.1 christos || (bfd_read (buffer, length, ibfd) != length)) 1648 1.1 christos { 1649 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 1650 1.1 christos error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB"); 1651 1.1 christos goto fail; 1652 1.1 christos } 1653 1.1 christos 1654 1.1 christos /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to 1655 1.1 christos extract the values this way in order to allow for a 1656 1.1 christos host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */ 1657 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer); 1658 1.1 christos if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL) 1659 1.1 christos goto fail; 1660 1.1 christos 1661 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8); 1662 1.1 christos if (datum != 0x2) 1663 1.1 christos goto fail; 1664 1.1 christos 1665 1.1 christos if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0) 1666 1.1 christos goto fail; 1667 1.1 christos 1668 1.1 christos /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */ 1669 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4); 1670 1.1 christos if (datum + 20 != length) 1671 1.1 christos goto fail; 1672 1.1 christos 1673 1.1 christos /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */ 1674 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4) 1675 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i)); 1676 1.1 christos } 1677 1.1 christos 1678 1.1 christos error_message = NULL; 1679 1.1 christos 1680 1.1 christos if (apuinfo_set) 1681 1.1 christos { 1682 1.1 christos /* Compute the size of the output section. */ 1683 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length (); 1684 1.9 christos 1685 1.1 christos /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */ 1686 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME); 1687 1.7 christos 1688 1.7 christos if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4)) 1689 1.1 christos { 1690 1.1 christos ibfd = abfd; 1691 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 1692 1.1 christos error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB"); 1693 1.10 christos } 1694 1.1 christos } 1695 1.1 christos 1696 1.7 christos fail: 1697 1.1 christos free (buffer); 1698 1.1 christos 1699 1.1 christos if (error_message) 1700 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd); 1701 1.1 christos } 1702 1.10 christos 1703 1.1 christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections' 1704 1.1 christos contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */ 1705 1.1 christos 1706 1.1 christos static bool 1707 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1708 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1709 1.1 christos asection *asec, 1710 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1711 1.1 christos { 1712 1.1 christos return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0; 1713 1.1 christos } 1714 1.9 christos 1715 1.1 christos /* Finally we can generate the output section. */ 1716 1.1 christos 1717 1.1 christos static void 1718 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd) 1719 1.1 christos { 1720 1.1 christos bfd_byte *buffer; 1721 1.1 christos asection *asec; 1722 1.1 christos unsigned i; 1723 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries; 1724 1.1 christos bfd_size_type length; 1725 1.1 christos 1726 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME); 1727 1.1 christos if (asec == NULL) 1728 1.1 christos return; 1729 1.1 christos 1730 1.1 christos if (!apuinfo_set) 1731 1.1 christos return; 1732 1.1 christos 1733 1.1 christos length = asec->size; 1734 1.1 christos if (length < 20) 1735 1.1 christos return; 1736 1.7 christos 1737 1.7 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (length); 1738 1.1 christos if (buffer == NULL) 1739 1.1 christos { 1740 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 1741 1.1 christos (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section")); 1742 1.1 christos return; 1743 1.1 christos } 1744 1.1 christos 1745 1.1 christos /* Create the apuinfo header. */ 1746 1.1 christos num_entries = apuinfo_list_length (); 1747 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer); 1748 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4); 1749 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8); 1750 1.1 christos strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL); 1751 1.1 christos 1752 1.1 christos length = 20; 1753 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) 1754 1.1 christos { 1755 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length); 1756 1.7 christos length += 4; 1757 1.1 christos } 1758 1.1 christos 1759 1.7 christos if (length != asec->size) 1760 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section")); 1761 1.1 christos 1762 1.1 christos if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length)) 1763 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section")); 1764 1.1 christos 1765 1.9 christos free (buffer); 1766 1.10 christos 1767 1.9 christos apuinfo_list_finish (); 1768 1.9 christos } 1769 1.9 christos 1770 1.9 christos static bool 1771 1.9 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd) 1772 1.1 christos { 1773 1.10 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd); 1774 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd); 1775 1.1 christos } 1776 1.7 christos 1777 1.1 christos static bool 1779 1.10 christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off) 1780 1.1 christos { 1781 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4 * 4]; 1782 1.1 christos 1783 1.1 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf)) 1784 1.1 christos return false; 1785 1.1 christos 1786 1.1 christos return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11 1787 1.10 christos && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11 1788 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11 1789 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR); 1790 1.1 christos } 1791 1.1 christos 1792 1.1 christos static bool 1793 1.1 christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr) 1794 1.1 christos { 1795 1.1 christos bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr; 1796 1.1 christos return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 1797 1.1 christos && section->vma <= vma 1798 1.1 christos && vma < section->vma + section->size); 1799 1.1 christos } 1800 1.1 christos 1801 1.10 christos static long 1802 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms, 1803 1.1 christos long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms, 1804 1.1 christos asymbol **ret) 1805 1.7 christos { 1806 1.1 christos bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool); 1807 1.1 christos asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink; 1808 1.9 christos bfd_vma glink_vma = 0; 1809 1.1 christos bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0; 1810 1.1 christos bfd_vma stub_off; 1811 1.1 christos asymbol *s; 1812 1.1 christos arelent *p; 1813 1.1 christos size_t count, i, stub_delta; 1814 1.1 christos size_t size; 1815 1.1 christos char *names; 1816 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4]; 1817 1.1 christos 1818 1.1 christos *ret = NULL; 1819 1.1 christos 1820 1.1 christos if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0) 1821 1.1 christos return 0; 1822 1.1 christos 1823 1.1 christos if (dynsymcount <= 0) 1824 1.1 christos return 0; 1825 1.1 christos 1826 1.1 christos relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt"); 1827 1.1 christos if (relplt == NULL) 1828 1.1 christos return 0; 1829 1.1 christos 1830 1.1 christos plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt"); 1831 1.1 christos if (plt == NULL) 1832 1.1 christos return 0; 1833 1.1 christos 1834 1.1 christos /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */ 1835 1.1 christos if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR) 1836 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms, 1837 1.11 christos dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret); 1838 1.11 christos 1839 1.1 christos /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address 1840 1.1 christos of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */ 1841 1.1 christos dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"); 1842 1.1 christos if (dynamic != NULL 1843 1.1 christos && (dynamic->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0) 1844 1.1 christos { 1845 1.1 christos bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend; 1846 1.1 christos size_t extdynsize; 1847 1.1 christos void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *); 1848 1.1 christos 1849 1.1 christos if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf)) 1850 1.11 christos return -1; 1851 1.11 christos 1852 1.11 christos extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn; 1853 1.1 christos swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in; 1854 1.1 christos 1855 1.1 christos for (extdyn = dynbuf, extdynend = dynbuf + dynamic->size; 1856 1.1 christos (size_t) (extdynend - extdyn) >= extdynsize; 1857 1.1 christos extdyn += extdynsize) 1858 1.1 christos { 1859 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn; 1860 1.1 christos (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn); 1861 1.1 christos 1862 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL) 1863 1.1 christos break; 1864 1.1 christos 1865 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT) 1866 1.1 christos { 1867 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val; 1868 1.1 christos asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got"); 1869 1.1 christos if (got != NULL 1870 1.1 christos && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf, 1871 1.1 christos g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4)) 1872 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf); 1873 1.1 christos break; 1874 1.1 christos } 1875 1.1 christos } 1876 1.1 christos free (dynbuf); 1877 1.1 christos } 1878 1.1 christos 1879 1.1 christos /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */ 1880 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0) 1881 1.1 christos { 1882 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4)) 1883 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf); 1884 1.1 christos } 1885 1.1 christos 1886 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0) 1887 1.1 christos return 0; 1888 1.1 christos 1889 1.1 christos /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final 1890 1.1 christos link; search for the section (usually .text) where the 1891 1.1 christos glink stubs now reside. */ 1892 1.1 christos glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma); 1893 1.1 christos if (glink == NULL) 1894 1.1 christos return 0; 1895 1.1 christos 1896 1.1 christos /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch 1897 1.1 christos from the first glink stub. */ 1898 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, 1899 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma, 4)) 1900 1.1 christos { 1901 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf); 1902 1.1 christos 1903 1.1 christos /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */ 1904 1.1 christos insn ^= B; 1905 1.1 christos if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0) 1906 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000; 1907 1.1 christos 1908 1.1 christos /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */ 1909 1.1 christos else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0) 1910 1.1 christos for (i = 4; 1911 1.1 christos bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, 1912 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4); 1913 1.1 christos i += 4) 1914 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP) 1915 1.1 christos { 1916 1.11 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + i; 1917 1.1 christos break; 1918 1.1 christos } 1919 1.1 christos } 1920 1.7 christos 1921 1.7 christos count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr); 1922 1.7 christos /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have 1923 1.7 christos multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then 1924 1.7 christos there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short 1925 1.7 christos of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub. 1926 1.7 christos The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of 1927 1.7 christos GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */ 1928 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma; 1929 1.1 christos for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8) 1930 1.1 christos if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta)) 1931 1.10 christos break; 1932 1.1 christos if (stub_delta > 32) 1933 1.1 christos return 0; 1934 1.1 christos 1935 1.1 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table; 1936 1.1 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true)) 1937 1.1 christos return -1; 1938 1.1 christos 1939 1.1 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol); 1940 1.1 christos p = relplt->relocation; 1941 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++) 1942 1.1 christos { 1943 1.1 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt"); 1944 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0) 1945 1.1 christos size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8; 1946 1.1 christos } 1947 1.1 christos 1948 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink"); 1949 1.1 christos 1950 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma) 1951 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"); 1952 1.7 christos 1953 1.1 christos s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size); 1954 1.3 christos if (s == NULL) 1955 1.3 christos return -1; 1956 1.1 christos 1957 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma; 1958 1.1 christos names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0)); 1959 1.7 christos p = relplt->relocation + count - 1; 1960 1.7 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++) 1961 1.7 christos { 1962 1.1 christos size_t len; 1963 1.1 christos 1964 1.1 christos stub_off -= stub_delta; 1965 1.1 christos if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0) 1966 1.1 christos stub_off -= 32; 1967 1.1 christos *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr; 1968 1.1 christos /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since 1969 1.7 christos we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */ 1970 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0) 1971 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL; 1972 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC; 1973 1.1 christos s->section = glink; 1974 1.1 christos s->value = stub_off; 1975 1.1 christos s->name = names; 1976 1.1 christos s->udata.p = NULL; 1977 1.1 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name); 1978 1.1 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len); 1979 1.1 christos names += len; 1980 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0) 1981 1.1 christos { 1982 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1); 1983 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1; 1984 1.1 christos bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend); 1985 1.3 christos names += strlen (names); 1986 1.1 christos } 1987 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt")); 1988 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("@plt"); 1989 1.1 christos ++s; 1990 1.1 christos --p; 1991 1.1 christos } 1992 1.1 christos 1993 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */ 1994 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s); 1995 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd; 1996 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC; 1997 1.1 christos s->section = glink; 1998 1.1 christos s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma; 1999 1.1 christos s->name = names; 2000 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink")); 2001 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink"); 2002 1.1 christos s++; 2003 1.1 christos count++; 2004 1.1 christos 2005 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma) 2006 1.1 christos { 2007 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */ 2008 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s); 2009 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd; 2010 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC; 2011 1.1 christos s->section = glink; 2012 1.1 christos s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma; 2013 1.1 christos s->name = names; 2014 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve")); 2015 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"); 2016 1.1 christos s++; 2017 1.1 christos count++; 2018 1.1 christos } 2019 1.1 christos 2020 1.1 christos return count; 2021 1.1 christos } 2022 1.1 christos 2023 1.1 christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while 2025 1.1 christos functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more 2026 1.1 christos or less in the order in which they are called. eg. 2027 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process, 2028 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions 2029 1.1 christos called. */ 2030 1.1 christos 2031 1.1 christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more 2032 1.1 christos than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */ 2033 1.1 christos struct plt_entry 2034 1.1 christos { 2035 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *next; 2036 1.1 christos 2037 1.1 christos /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2". 2038 1.1 christos This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the 2039 1.1 christos GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current 2040 1.1 christos gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2 2041 1.1 christos sections together resulting in larger offsets). */ 2042 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend; 2043 1.1 christos 2044 1.1 christos /* The .got2 section. */ 2045 1.1 christos asection *sec; 2046 1.1 christos 2047 1.1 christos /* PLT refcount or offset. */ 2048 1.1 christos union 2049 1.1 christos { 2050 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount; 2051 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset; 2052 1.7 christos } plt; 2053 1.7 christos 2054 1.7 christos /* .glink stub offset. */ 2055 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_offset; 2056 1.1 christos }; 2057 1.1 christos 2058 1.1 christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this 2059 1.1 christos function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared 2060 1.1 christos library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */ 2061 1.1 christos 2062 1.1 christos static int 2063 1.7 christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info, 2064 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type) 2065 1.7 christos { 2066 1.7 christos switch (r_type) 2067 1.1 christos { 2068 1.1 christos default: 2069 1.1 christos /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load 2070 1.1 christos address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the 2071 1.1 christos dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from 2072 1.1 christos local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */ 2073 1.1 christos return 1; 2074 1.1 christos 2075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24: 2076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14: 2077 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 2078 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 2079 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32: 2080 1.1 christos return 0; 2081 1.7 christos 2082 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32: 2083 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16: 2084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO: 2085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI: 2086 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 2087 1.1 christos /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the 2088 1.1 christos linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */ 2089 1.1 christos return bfd_link_dll (info); 2090 1.1 christos } 2091 1.1 christos } 2092 1.1 christos 2093 1.3 christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid 2094 1.3 christos copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss 2095 1.3 christos section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the 2096 1.3 christos shared lib. */ 2097 1.3 christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1 2098 1.3 christos 2099 1.3 christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */ 2100 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs 2101 1.3 christos { 2102 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next; 2103 1.3 christos 2104 1.3 christos /* The input section of the reloc. */ 2105 1.3 christos asection *sec; 2106 1.3 christos 2107 1.3 christos /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */ 2108 1.1 christos unsigned int count : 31; 2109 1.1 christos 2110 1.1 christos /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */ 2111 1.1 christos unsigned int ifunc : 1; 2112 1.1 christos }; 2113 1.1 christos 2114 1.1 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */ 2115 1.1 christos 2116 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry 2117 1.1 christos { 2118 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry elf; 2119 1.7 christos 2120 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor 2121 1.7 christos specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset 2122 1.7 christos from the beginning of the section. */ 2123 1.7 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer; 2124 1.7 christos 2125 1.9 christos /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT. 2126 1.7 christos Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are 2127 1.7 christos encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any 2128 1.7 christos of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when 2129 1.7 christos optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not 2130 1.7 christos needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also 2131 1.7 christos set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one. 2132 1.7 christos These flags are also kept for local symbols. */ 2133 1.9 christos #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */ 2134 1.7 christos #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */ 2135 1.7 christos #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */ 2136 1.7 christos #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */ 2137 1.7 christos #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */ 2138 1.7 christos #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */ 2139 1.7 christos #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */ 2140 1.7 christos unsigned char tls_mask; 2141 1.1 christos 2142 1.1 christos /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which 2143 1.1 christos case TLS_TLS will be 0. */ 2144 1.3 christos #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */ 2145 1.3 christos #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */ 2146 1.3 christos #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */ 2147 1.3 christos 2148 1.3 christos /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this 2149 1.1 christos symbol. */ 2150 1.1 christos unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1; 2151 1.1 christos 2152 1.1 christos /* Flag use of given relocations. */ 2153 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1; 2154 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1; 2155 1.1 christos }; 2156 1.1 christos 2157 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent)) 2158 1.1 christos 2159 1.3 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */ 2160 1.3 christos 2161 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table 2162 1.1 christos { 2163 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table elf; 2164 1.1 christos 2165 1.1 christos /* Various options passed from the linker. */ 2166 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_params *params; 2167 1.1 christos 2168 1.1 christos /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */ 2169 1.7 christos asection *glink; 2170 1.7 christos asection *dynsbss; 2171 1.1 christos asection *relsbss; 2172 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t sdata[2]; 2173 1.1 christos asection *sbss; 2174 1.1 christos asection *glink_eh_frame; 2175 1.1 christos asection *pltlocal; 2176 1.1 christos asection *relpltlocal; 2177 1.1 christos 2178 1.1 christos /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */ 2179 1.1 christos asection *srelplt2; 2180 1.1 christos 2181 1.1 christos /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */ 2182 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr; 2183 1.1 christos 2184 1.1 christos /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */ 2185 1.1 christos bfd *old_bfd; 2186 1.1 christos 2187 1.1 christos /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */ 2188 1.1 christos union { 2189 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount; 2190 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset; 2191 1.1 christos } tlsld_got; 2192 1.1 christos 2193 1.1 christos /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */ 2194 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_pltresolve; 2195 1.1 christos 2196 1.1 christos /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */ 2197 1.1 christos unsigned int got_header_size; 2198 1.7 christos /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */ 2199 1.7 christos unsigned int got_gap; 2200 1.7 christos 2201 1.7 christos /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */ 2202 1.7 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type; 2203 1.7 christos 2204 1.7 christos /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers, 2205 1.7 christos referenced by dynamic relocations. */ 2206 1.7 christos unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1; 2207 1.7 christos unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1; 2208 1.7 christos 2209 1.1 christos /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */ 2210 1.1 christos unsigned int do_tls_opt:1; 2211 1.1 christos 2212 1.1 christos /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */ 2213 1.1 christos unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1; 2214 1.1 christos 2215 1.1 christos /* The size of PLT entries. */ 2216 1.1 christos int plt_entry_size; 2217 1.1 christos /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */ 2218 1.1 christos int plt_slot_size; 2219 1.1 christos /* The size of the first PLT entry. */ 2220 1.1 christos int plt_initial_entry_size; 2221 1.1 christos }; 2222 1.1 christos 2223 1.9 christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they 2224 1.9 christos are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */ 2225 1.9 christos 2226 1.1 christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */ 2227 1.7 christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0 2228 1.7 christos 2229 1.7 christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker 2230 1.1 christos relocs. */ 2231 1.1 christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1 2232 1.1 christos 2233 1.10 christos /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */ 2234 1.10 christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2 2235 1.10 christos 2236 1.1 christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */ 2237 1.1 christos 2238 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \ 2239 1.1 christos ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \ 2240 1.1 christos && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) \ 2241 1.1 christos ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL) 2242 1.1 christos 2243 1.1 christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */ 2244 1.1 christos 2245 1.1 christos static struct bfd_hash_entry * 2246 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry, 2247 1.1 christos struct bfd_hash_table *table, 2248 1.1 christos const char *string) 2249 1.1 christos { 2250 1.1 christos /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a 2251 1.1 christos subclass. */ 2252 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL) 2253 1.1 christos { 2254 1.1 christos entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, 2255 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry)); 2256 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL) 2257 1.1 christos return entry; 2258 1.1 christos } 2259 1.1 christos 2260 1.1 christos /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */ 2261 1.1 christos entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string); 2262 1.1 christos if (entry != NULL) 2263 1.1 christos { 2264 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL; 2265 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0; 2266 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0; 2267 1.1 christos } 2268 1.1 christos 2269 1.1 christos return entry; 2270 1.1 christos } 2271 1.1 christos 2272 1.7 christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */ 2273 1.7 christos 2274 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table * 2275 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd) 2276 1.1 christos { 2277 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret; 2278 1.1 christos static struct ppc_elf_params default_params 2279 1.1 christos = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 }; 2280 1.1 christos 2281 1.12 christos ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table)); 2282 1.1 christos if (ret == NULL) 2283 1.1 christos return NULL; 2284 1.1 christos 2285 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd, 2286 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc, 2287 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry))) 2288 1.1 christos { 2289 1.1 christos free (ret); 2290 1.1 christos return NULL; 2291 1.1 christos } 2292 1.3 christos 2293 1.3 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0; 2294 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL; 2295 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0; 2296 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL; 2297 1.1 christos 2298 1.1 christos ret->params = &default_params; 2299 1.1 christos 2300 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata"; 2301 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_"; 2302 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss"; 2303 1.1 christos 2304 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2"; 2305 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_"; 2306 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2"; 2307 1.1 christos 2308 1.1 christos ret->plt_entry_size = 12; 2309 1.3 christos ret->plt_slot_size = 8; 2310 1.3 christos ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72; 2311 1.3 christos 2312 1.3 christos return &ret->elf.root; 2313 1.3 christos } 2314 1.3 christos 2315 1.3 christos /* Hook linker params into hash table. */ 2316 1.3 christos 2317 1.3 christos void 2318 1.7 christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params) 2319 1.3 christos { 2320 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2321 1.1 christos 2322 1.1 christos if (htab) 2323 1.10 christos htab->params = params; 2324 1.1 christos params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize); 2325 1.1 christos } 2326 1.1 christos 2327 1.1 christos /* Create .got and the related sections. */ 2328 1.1 christos 2329 1.10 christos static bool 2330 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 2331 1.1 christos { 2332 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 2333 1.1 christos 2334 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info)) 2335 1.1 christos return false; 2336 1.7 christos 2337 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2338 1.9 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks) 2339 1.10 christos { 2340 1.1 christos /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it 2341 1.1 christos executable. */ 2342 1.10 christos flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 2343 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2344 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags)) 2345 1.3 christos return false; 2346 1.3 christos } 2347 1.3 christos 2348 1.3 christos return true; 2349 1.10 christos } 2350 1.3 christos 2351 1.3 christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and 2352 1.3 christos R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata 2353 1.3 christos and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */ 2354 1.3 christos 2355 1.3 christos static bool 2356 1.3 christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd, 2357 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 2358 1.3 christos flagword flags, 2359 1.3 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect) 2360 1.3 christos { 2361 1.3 christos asection *s; 2362 1.10 christos 2363 1.3 christos flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY 2364 1.3 christos | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2365 1.3 christos 2366 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags); 2367 1.3 christos if (s == NULL) 2368 1.3 christos return false; 2369 1.3 christos lsect->section = s; 2370 1.10 christos 2371 1.3 christos /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */ 2372 1.10 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name); 2373 1.3 christos 2374 1.3 christos lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name); 2375 1.10 christos if (lsect->sym == NULL) 2376 1.1 christos return false; 2377 1.1 christos lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000; 2378 1.1 christos return true; 2379 1.1 christos } 2380 1.1 christos 2381 1.7 christos static bool 2382 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 2383 1.1 christos { 2384 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2385 1.1 christos asection *s; 2386 1.1 christos flagword flags; 2387 1.7 christos int p2align; 2388 1.7 christos 2389 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 2390 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2391 1.9 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags); 2392 1.10 christos htab->glink = s; 2393 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4; 2394 1.1 christos if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align) 2395 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align; 2396 1.1 christos if (s == NULL 2397 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align)) 2398 1.1 christos return false; 2399 1.1 christos 2400 1.1 christos if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info) 2401 1.9 christos { 2402 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 2403 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2404 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags); 2405 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame = s; 2406 1.1 christos if (s == NULL 2407 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2)) 2408 1.1 christos return false; 2409 1.9 christos } 2410 1.10 christos 2411 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED; 2412 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags); 2413 1.1 christos htab->elf.iplt = s; 2414 1.1 christos if (s == NULL 2415 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4)) 2416 1.1 christos return false; 2417 1.9 christos 2418 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 2419 1.3 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2420 1.7 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags); 2421 1.7 christos htab->elf.irelplt = s; 2422 1.7 christos if (s == NULL 2423 1.7 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2)) 2424 1.7 christos return false; 2425 1.7 christos 2426 1.9 christos /* Local plt entries. */ 2427 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD 2428 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2429 1.7 christos htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt", 2430 1.7 christos flags); 2431 1.7 christos if (htab->pltlocal == NULL 2432 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2)) 2433 1.7 christos return false; 2434 1.7 christos 2435 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 2436 1.9 christos { 2437 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY 2438 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2439 1.7 christos htab->relpltlocal 2440 1.3 christos = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags); 2441 1.3 christos if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL 2442 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2)) 2443 1.3 christos return false; 2444 1.3 christos } 2445 1.3 christos 2446 1.10 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0, 2447 1.3 christos &htab->sdata[0])) 2448 1.10 christos return false; 2449 1.1 christos 2450 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY, 2451 1.1 christos &htab->sdata[1])) 2452 1.1 christos return false; 2453 1.1 christos 2454 1.1 christos return true; 2455 1.10 christos } 2456 1.1 christos 2457 1.1 christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped 2458 1.1 christos to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has 2459 1.1 christos to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */ 2460 1.1 christos 2461 1.1 christos static bool 2462 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 2463 1.1 christos { 2464 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 2465 1.1 christos asection *s; 2466 1.10 christos flagword flags; 2467 1.1 christos 2468 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2469 1.10 christos 2470 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL 2471 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info)) 2472 1.1 christos return false; 2473 1.10 christos 2474 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info)) 2475 1.1 christos return false; 2476 1.1 christos 2477 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL 2478 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info)) 2479 1.10 christos return false; 2480 1.1 christos 2481 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss", 2482 1.1 christos SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2483 1.1 christos htab->dynsbss = s; 2484 1.1 christos if (s == NULL) 2485 1.1 christos return false; 2486 1.1 christos 2487 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)) 2488 1.9 christos { 2489 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 2490 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2491 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags); 2492 1.10 christos htab->relsbss = s; 2493 1.1 christos if (s == NULL 2494 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2)) 2495 1.1 christos return false; 2496 1.7 christos } 2497 1.1 christos 2498 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks 2499 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2)) 2500 1.1 christos return false; 2501 1.9 christos 2502 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.splt; 2503 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED; 2504 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS) 2505 1.1 christos /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */ 2506 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY; 2507 1.1 christos return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags); 2508 1.1 christos } 2509 1.1 christos 2510 1.1 christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */ 2511 1.1 christos 2512 1.1 christos static void 2513 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, 2514 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir, 2515 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind) 2516 1.1 christos { 2517 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind; 2518 1.1 christos 2519 1.7 christos edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir; 2520 1.7 christos eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind; 2521 1.1 christos 2522 1.1 christos edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask; 2523 1.7 christos edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs; 2524 1.1 christos 2525 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden) 2526 1.1 christos edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic; 2527 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular; 2528 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak; 2529 1.7 christos edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref; 2530 1.7 christos edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt; 2531 1.10 christos edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed; 2532 1.1 christos 2533 1.10 christos /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */ 2534 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect) 2535 1.1 christos return; 2536 1.1 christos 2537 1.1 christos if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL) 2538 1.1 christos { 2539 1.1 christos if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL) 2540 1.10 christos { 2541 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp; 2542 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p; 2543 1.1 christos 2544 1.10 christos /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym 2545 1.1 christos list. Merge any entries against the same section. */ 2546 1.1 christos for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; ) 2547 1.1 christos { 2548 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *q; 2549 1.1 christos 2550 1.1 christos for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next) 2551 1.1 christos if (q->sec == p->sec) 2552 1.1 christos { 2553 1.1 christos q->pc_count += p->pc_count; 2554 1.1 christos q->count += p->count; 2555 1.10 christos *pp = p->next; 2556 1.1 christos break; 2557 1.1 christos } 2558 1.10 christos if (q == NULL) 2559 1.10 christos pp = &p->next; 2560 1.1 christos } 2561 1.1 christos *pp = dir->dyn_relocs; 2562 1.1 christos } 2563 1.1 christos 2564 1.1 christos dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs; 2565 1.1 christos ind->dyn_relocs = NULL; 2566 1.1 christos } 2567 1.1 christos 2568 1.1 christos /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to 2569 1.1 christos the symbol which just became indirect. */ 2570 1.1 christos edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount; 2571 1.1 christos eind->elf.got.refcount = 0; 2572 1.1 christos 2573 1.1 christos /* And plt entries. */ 2574 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL) 2575 1.1 christos { 2576 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL) 2577 1.1 christos { 2578 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **entp; 2579 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 2580 1.1 christos 2581 1.1 christos for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; ) 2582 1.1 christos { 2583 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *dent; 2584 1.1 christos 2585 1.1 christos for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next) 2586 1.1 christos if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend) 2587 1.1 christos { 2588 1.1 christos dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount; 2589 1.1 christos *entp = ent->next; 2590 1.1 christos break; 2591 1.1 christos } 2592 1.1 christos if (dent == NULL) 2593 1.1 christos entp = &ent->next; 2594 1.1 christos } 2595 1.1 christos *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist; 2596 1.1 christos } 2597 1.1 christos 2598 1.1 christos edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist; 2599 1.1 christos eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL; 2600 1.1 christos } 2601 1.1 christos 2602 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1) 2603 1.1 christos { 2604 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1) 2605 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr, 2606 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index); 2607 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx; 2608 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index; 2609 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynindx = -1; 2610 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0; 2611 1.10 christos } 2612 1.1 christos } 2613 1.1 christos 2614 1.1 christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object 2615 1.1 christos file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */ 2616 1.1 christos 2617 1.1 christos static bool 2618 1.1 christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, 2619 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 2620 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, 2621 1.3 christos const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 2622 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 2623 1.1 christos asection **secp, 2624 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp) 2625 1.1 christos { 2626 1.1 christos if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON 2627 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_relocatable (info) 2628 1.1 christos && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd) 2629 1.1 christos && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd)) 2630 1.1 christos { 2631 1.1 christos /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically 2632 1.10 christos put into .sbss. */ 2633 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 2634 1.1 christos 2635 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2636 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL) 2637 1.1 christos { 2638 1.1 christos flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED; 2639 1.1 christos 2640 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynobj) 2641 1.10 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd; 2642 1.1 christos 2643 1.1 christos htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, 2644 1.1 christos ".sbss", 2645 1.1 christos flags); 2646 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL) 2647 1.1 christos return false; 2648 1.10 christos } 2649 1.1 christos 2650 1.1 christos *secp = htab->sbss; 2651 1.1 christos *valp = sym->st_size; 2652 1.1 christos } 2653 1.1 christos 2654 1.1 christos return true; 2655 1.1 christos } 2656 1.1 christos 2657 1.1 christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */ 2659 1.1 christos 2660 1.1 christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t * 2661 1.1 christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section 2662 1.1 christos (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers, 2663 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend, 2664 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect) 2665 1.1 christos { 2666 1.1 christos for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next) 2667 1.1 christos if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend) 2668 1.10 christos return linker_pointers; 2669 1.3 christos 2670 1.3 christos return NULL; 2671 1.3 christos } 2672 1.3 christos 2673 1.1 christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */ 2674 1.1 christos 2675 1.1 christos static bool 2676 1.1 christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd, 2677 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect, 2678 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 2679 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel) 2680 1.1 christos { 2681 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL; 2682 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr; 2683 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 2684 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt; 2685 1.1 christos 2686 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL); 2687 1.1 christos 2688 1.1 christos /* Is this a global symbol? */ 2689 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 2690 1.1 christos { 2691 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh; 2692 1.1 christos 2693 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */ 2694 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 2695 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer, 2696 1.1 christos rel->r_addend, 2697 1.1 christos lsect)) 2698 1.1 christos return true; 2699 1.1 christos 2700 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer; 2701 1.1 christos } 2702 1.1 christos else 2703 1.1 christos { 2704 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd)); 2705 1.1 christos 2706 1.1 christos /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */ 2707 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd); 2708 1.1 christos 2709 1.1 christos /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */ 2710 1.1 christos if (!ptr) 2711 1.1 christos { 2712 1.10 christos unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info; 2713 1.1 christos 2714 1.1 christos amt = num_symbols; 2715 1.1 christos amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *); 2716 1.1 christos ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 2717 1.1 christos 2718 1.1 christos if (!ptr) 2719 1.1 christos return false; 2720 1.1 christos 2721 1.10 christos elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr; 2722 1.1 christos } 2723 1.1 christos 2724 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */ 2725 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx], 2726 1.1 christos rel->r_addend, 2727 1.1 christos lsect)) 2728 1.1 christos return true; 2729 1.1 christos 2730 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx]; 2731 1.1 christos } 2732 1.1 christos 2733 1.10 christos /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate 2734 1.1 christos a new pointer record from internal memory. */ 2735 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL); 2736 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t); 2737 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt); 2738 1.1 christos 2739 1.1 christos if (!linker_section_ptr) 2740 1.9 christos return false; 2741 1.10 christos 2742 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr; 2743 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend; 2744 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect; 2745 1.1 christos *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr; 2746 1.1 christos 2747 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2)) 2748 1.1 christos return false; 2749 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size; 2750 1.1 christos lsect->section->size += 4; 2751 1.1 christos 2752 1.10 christos #ifdef DEBUG 2753 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, 2754 1.1 christos "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n", 2755 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset, 2756 1.1 christos (long) lsect->section->size); 2757 1.1 christos #endif 2758 1.1 christos 2759 1.1 christos return true; 2760 1.1 christos } 2761 1.1 christos 2762 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry ** 2763 1.7 christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, 2764 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr, 2765 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx, 2766 1.1 christos int tls_type) 2767 1.1 christos { 2768 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd); 2769 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 2770 1.1 christos unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks; 2771 1.1 christos 2772 1.1 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL) 2773 1.1 christos { 2774 1.1 christos bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info; 2775 1.1 christos 2776 1.1 christos size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts) 2777 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_plt) 2778 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks)); 2779 1.7 christos local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size); 2780 1.7 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL) 2781 1.7 christos return NULL; 2782 1.1 christos elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts; 2783 1.1 christos } 2784 1.1 christos 2785 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 2786 1.10 christos local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 2787 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff; 2788 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0) 2789 1.1 christos local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1; 2790 1.1 christos return local_plt + r_symndx; 2791 1.1 christos } 2792 1.1 christos 2793 1.1 christos static bool 2794 1.1 christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, 2795 1.1 christos asection *sec, bfd_vma addend) 2796 1.1 christos { 2797 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 2798 1.1 christos 2799 1.10 christos if (addend < 32768) 2800 1.1 christos sec = NULL; 2801 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 2802 1.10 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend) 2803 1.1 christos break; 2804 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL) 2805 1.1 christos { 2806 1.1 christos size_t amt = sizeof (*ent); 2807 1.1 christos ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt); 2808 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL) 2809 1.1 christos return false; 2810 1.10 christos ent->next = *plist; 2811 1.1 christos ent->sec = sec; 2812 1.1 christos ent->addend = addend; 2813 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount = 0; 2814 1.1 christos *plist = ent; 2815 1.1 christos } 2816 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount += 1; 2817 1.1 christos return true; 2818 1.1 christos } 2819 1.1 christos 2820 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry * 2821 1.1 christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend) 2822 1.1 christos { 2823 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 2824 1.1 christos 2825 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768) 2826 1.10 christos sec = NULL; 2827 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 2828 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend) 2829 1.1 christos break; 2830 1.1 christos return ent; 2831 1.1 christos } 2832 1.1 christos 2833 1.1 christos static bool 2834 1.1 christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type) 2835 1.1 christos { 2836 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 2837 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC 2838 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL24 2839 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14 2840 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN 2841 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN 2842 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24 2843 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14 2844 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN 2845 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN 2846 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24); 2847 1.7 christos } 2848 1.7 christos 2849 1.7 christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */ 2850 1.7 christos 2851 1.1 christos static bool 2852 1.1 christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type) 2853 1.10 christos { 2854 1.10 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA 2855 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 2856 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 2857 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ); 2858 1.10 christos } 2859 1.10 christos 2860 1.10 christos /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto. Return true 2861 1.10 christos iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits. */ 2862 1.1 christos 2863 1.1 christos static bool 2864 1.1 christos offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size) 2865 1.7 christos { 2866 1.7 christos return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset; 2867 1.7 christos } 2868 1.1 christos 2869 1.1 christos static void 2870 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type) 2871 1.1 christos { 2872 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 2873 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 2874 1.1 christos (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"), 2875 1.1 christos abfd, 2876 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name); 2877 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 2878 1.1 christos } 2879 1.1 christos 2880 1.1 christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and 2881 1.1 christos allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage 2882 1.1 christos table. */ 2883 1.1 christos 2884 1.1 christos static bool 2885 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, 2886 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 2887 1.1 christos asection *sec, 2888 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs) 2889 1.1 christos { 2890 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 2891 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 2892 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 2893 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel; 2894 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end; 2895 1.7 christos asection *got2, *sreloc; 2896 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga; 2897 1.1 christos 2898 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) 2899 1.1 christos return true; 2900 1.1 christos 2901 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 2902 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB", 2903 1.1 christos sec, abfd); 2904 1.1 christos #endif 2905 1.1 christos 2906 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd)); 2907 1.1 christos 2908 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */ 2909 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32]) 2910 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (); 2911 1.10 christos 2912 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 2913 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL) 2914 1.10 christos { 2915 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL) 2916 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd; 2917 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info)) 2918 1.1 christos return false; 2919 1.1 christos } 2920 1.1 christos tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr", 2921 1.1 christos false, false, true); 2922 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd); 2923 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd); 2924 1.1 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2"); 2925 1.1 christos sreloc = NULL; 2926 1.10 christos 2927 1.1 christos rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count; 2928 1.3 christos for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++) 2929 1.7 christos { 2930 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx; 2931 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 2932 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 2933 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym; 2934 1.10 christos int tls_type; 2935 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc; 2936 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **pltent; 2937 1.10 christos bfd_vma addend; 2938 1.10 christos 2939 1.10 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 2940 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info) 2941 1.1 christos { 2942 1.1 christos h = NULL; 2943 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx); 2944 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL) 2945 1.1 christos return false; 2946 1.10 christos } 2947 1.1 christos else 2948 1.1 christos { 2949 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 2950 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 2951 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 2952 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 2953 1.7 christos isym = NULL; 2954 1.1 christos } 2955 1.1 christos 2956 1.1 christos /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got. 2957 1.1 christos This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi 2958 1.1 christos startup code. */ 2959 1.10 christos if (h != NULL 2960 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot == NULL 2961 1.1 christos && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0) 2962 1.1 christos { 2963 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL) 2964 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd; 2965 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info)) 2966 1.10 christos return false; 2967 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot); 2968 1.10 christos } 2969 1.10 christos 2970 1.10 christos tls_type = 0; 2971 1.10 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info); 2972 1.10 christos ifunc = NULL; 2973 1.10 christos if (h != NULL) 2974 1.10 christos { 2975 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 2976 1.3 christos { 2977 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1; 2978 1.3 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist; 2979 1.1 christos } 2980 1.7 christos } 2981 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks) 2982 1.10 christos { 2983 1.1 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 2984 1.1 christos { 2985 1.1 christos /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */ 2986 1.1 christos ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, 2987 1.3 christos NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC); 2988 1.7 christos if (ifunc == NULL) 2989 1.7 christos return false; 2990 1.7 christos 2991 1.7 christos /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry; 2992 1.1 christos In a non-pie executable even when there are 2993 1.7 christos no plt calls. */ 2994 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) 2995 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type) 2996 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 2997 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 2998 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA) 2999 1.7 christos { 3000 1.7 christos addend = 0; 3001 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24) 3002 1.3 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1; 3003 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 3004 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 3005 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 3006 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 3007 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)) 3008 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend; 3009 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend)) 3010 1.1 christos return false; 3011 1.1 christos } 3012 1.1 christos } 3013 1.1 christos } 3014 1.1 christos 3015 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks 3016 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type) 3017 1.1 christos && h != NULL 3018 1.1 christos && h == tga) 3019 1.1 christos { 3020 1.1 christos if (rel != relocs 3021 1.9 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD 3022 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD)) 3023 1.1 christos /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker 3024 1.10 christos reloc. */ 3025 1.1 christos ; 3026 1.1 christos else 3027 1.1 christos /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */ 3028 1.1 christos sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1; 3029 1.1 christos } 3030 1.7 christos 3031 1.7 christos switch (r_type) 3032 1.7 christos { 3033 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD: 3034 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD: 3035 1.10 christos /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with 3036 1.7 christos its parameter symbol. */ 3037 1.7 christos if (h != NULL) 3038 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK; 3039 1.1 christos else 3040 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, 3041 1.1 christos NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)) 3042 1.1 christos return false; 3043 1.1 christos break; 3044 1.1 christos 3045 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ: 3046 1.1 christos break; 3047 1.1 christos 3048 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: 3049 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: 3050 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: 3051 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: 3052 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD; 3053 1.1 christos goto dogottls; 3054 1.1 christos 3055 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: 3056 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: 3057 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: 3058 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: 3059 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD; 3060 1.1 christos goto dogottls; 3061 1.1 christos 3062 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: 3063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: 3064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: 3065 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: 3066 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info)) 3067 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS; 3068 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL; 3069 1.1 christos goto dogottls; 3070 1.1 christos 3071 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: 3072 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: 3073 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: 3074 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: 3075 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL; 3076 1.1 christos dogottls: 3077 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1; 3078 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 3079 1.7 christos 3080 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations */ 3081 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16: 3082 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO: 3083 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI: 3084 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA: 3085 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */ 3086 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL) 3087 1.1 christos { 3088 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL) 3089 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd; 3090 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info)) 3091 1.1 christos return false; 3092 1.1 christos } 3093 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 3094 1.10 christos { 3095 1.1 christos h->got.refcount += 1; 3096 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type; 3097 1.1 christos } 3098 1.3 christos else 3099 1.1 christos /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */ 3100 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type)) 3101 1.10 christos return false; 3102 1.1 christos 3103 1.1 christos /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be 3104 1.1 christos an ifunc. */ 3105 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info)) 3106 1.1 christos { 3107 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0)) 3108 1.3 christos return false; 3109 1.3 christos } 3110 1.10 christos break; 3111 1.1 christos 3112 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */ 3113 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: 3114 1.10 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1; 3115 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0], 3116 1.1 christos h, rel)) 3117 1.1 christos return false; 3118 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 3119 1.1 christos { 3120 1.9 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true; 3121 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3122 1.1 christos } 3123 1.10 christos break; 3124 1.1 christos 3125 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */ 3126 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: 3127 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info)) 3128 1.10 christos { 3129 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type); 3130 1.1 christos return false; 3131 1.10 christos } 3132 1.10 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1; 3133 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1], 3134 1.1 christos h, rel)) 3135 1.1 christos return false; 3136 1.3 christos if (h != NULL) 3137 1.3 christos { 3138 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true; 3139 1.3 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3140 1.1 christos } 3141 1.1 christos break; 3142 1.1 christos 3143 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16: 3144 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1; 3145 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 3146 1.1 christos 3147 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A: 3148 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D: 3149 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A: 3150 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D: 3151 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A: 3152 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D: 3153 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 3154 1.1 christos { 3155 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true; 3156 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3157 1.1 christos } 3158 1.1 christos break; 3159 1.1 christos 3160 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8: 3161 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15: 3162 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24: 3163 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A: 3164 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D: 3165 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A: 3166 1.9 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D: 3167 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A: 3168 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D: 3169 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20: 3170 1.1 christos break; 3171 1.3 christos 3172 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: 3173 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info)) 3174 1.10 christos { 3175 1.10 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type); 3176 1.1 christos return false; 3177 1.1 christos } 3178 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1; 3179 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 3180 1.1 christos { 3181 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true; 3182 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3183 1.1 christos } 3184 1.1 christos break; 3185 1.10 christos 3186 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: 3187 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21: 3188 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21: 3189 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: 3190 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 3191 1.1 christos { 3192 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true; 3193 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3194 1.1 christos } 3195 1.1 christos break; 3196 1.10 christos 3197 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: 3198 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: 3199 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: 3200 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: 3201 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: 3202 1.7 christos if (h != NULL) 3203 1.7 christos h->non_got_ref = true; 3204 1.7 christos break; 3205 1.7 christos 3206 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24: 3207 1.7 christos if (h == NULL) 3208 1.7 christos break; 3209 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1; 3210 1.1 christos goto pltentry; 3211 1.1 christos 3212 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL: 3213 1.1 christos sec->has_pltcall = 1; 3214 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */ 3215 1.1 christos 3216 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32: 3217 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32: 3218 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO: 3219 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI: 3220 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA: 3221 1.7 christos pltentry: 3222 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG 3223 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n"); 3224 1.10 christos #endif 3225 1.7 christos /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */ 3226 1.7 christos if (h == NULL) 3227 1.1 christos { 3228 1.7 christos pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, 3229 1.7 christos NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP); 3230 1.1 christos if (pltent == NULL) 3231 1.7 christos return false; 3232 1.1 christos } 3233 1.7 christos else 3234 1.7 christos { 3235 1.7 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24) 3236 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP; 3237 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 1; 3238 1.7 christos pltent = &h->plt.plist; 3239 1.7 christos } 3240 1.7 christos addend = 0; 3241 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 3242 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 3243 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 3244 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 3245 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)) 3246 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend; 3247 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend)) 3248 1.1 christos return false; 3249 1.1 christos break; 3250 1.1 christos 3251 1.1 christos /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the 3252 1.1 christos relocation if linking a shared object since they are 3253 1.1 christos section relative. */ 3254 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF: 3255 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO: 3256 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI: 3257 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA: 3258 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16: 3259 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: 3260 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: 3261 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: 3262 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: 3263 1.1 christos break; 3264 1.1 christos 3265 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16: 3266 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO: 3267 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI: 3268 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA: 3269 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA: 3270 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1; 3271 1.1 christos break; 3272 1.1 christos 3273 1.1 christos /* These are just markers. */ 3274 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLS: 3275 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: 3276 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE: 3277 1.1 christos case R_PPC_max: 3278 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX: 3279 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT: 3280 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24: 3281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_16DX_HA: 3282 1.1 christos break; 3283 1.1 christos 3284 1.1 christos /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */ 3285 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY: 3286 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT: 3287 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT: 3288 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE: 3289 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE: 3290 1.1 christos break; 3291 1.1 christos 3292 1.1 christos /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */ 3293 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30: 3294 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: 3295 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: 3296 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: 3297 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: 3298 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: 3299 1.1 christos break; 3300 1.1 christos 3301 1.10 christos /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */ 3302 1.10 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC: 3303 1.10 christos if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET) 3304 1.10 christos { 3305 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD; 3306 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd; 3307 1.1 christos } 3308 1.1 christos if (h != NULL 3309 1.1 christos && ifunc != NULL 3310 1.1 christos && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0)) 3311 1.10 christos return false; 3312 1.1 christos break; 3313 1.1 christos 3314 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy. 3315 1.1 christos Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */ 3316 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT: 3317 1.9 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset)) 3318 1.10 christos return false; 3319 1.1 christos break; 3320 1.1 christos 3321 1.10 christos /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually 3322 1.10 christos used. Record for later use during GC. */ 3323 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY: 3324 1.10 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend)) 3325 1.7 christos return false; 3326 1.1 christos break; 3327 1.1 christos 3328 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI: 3329 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 3330 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1; 3331 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 3332 1.1 christos /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */ 3333 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32: 3334 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16: 3335 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO: 3336 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info)) 3337 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS; 3338 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 3339 1.1 christos 3340 1.1 christos /* Nor these. */ 3341 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32: 3342 1.3 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32: 3343 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 3344 1.1 christos 3345 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32: 3346 1.1 christos if (h == NULL 3347 1.1 christos && got2 != NULL 3348 1.1 christos && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0 3349 1.1 christos && bfd_link_pic (info) 3350 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET) 3351 1.1 christos { 3352 1.1 christos /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before 3353 1.1 christos the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32 3354 1.1 christos reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then 3355 1.1 christos force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot 3356 1.1 christos reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for 3357 1.1 christos PLT call stubs. */ 3358 1.1 christos asection *s; 3359 1.1 christos 3360 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx); 3361 1.1 christos if (s == got2) 3362 1.1 christos { 3363 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD; 3364 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd; 3365 1.1 christos } 3366 1.1 christos } 3367 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot) 3368 1.1 christos break; 3369 1.1 christos /* fall through */ 3370 1.1 christos 3371 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32: 3372 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16: 3373 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO: 3374 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI: 3375 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA: 3376 1.10 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32: 3377 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16: 3378 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info)) 3379 1.1 christos { 3380 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be 3381 1.3 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */ 3382 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0)) 3383 1.3 christos return false; 3384 1.3 christos 3385 1.1 christos /* We may need a copy reloc too. */ 3386 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = 1; 3387 1.1 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 1; 3388 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA) 3389 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1; 3390 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO) 3391 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1; 3392 1.1 christos } 3393 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 3394 1.1 christos 3395 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24: 3396 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14: 3397 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 3398 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 3399 1.1 christos if (h == NULL) 3400 1.1 christos break; 3401 1.1 christos if (h == htab->elf.hgot) 3402 1.1 christos { 3403 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET) 3404 1.1 christos { 3405 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD; 3406 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd; 3407 1.1 christos } 3408 1.1 christos break; 3409 1.3 christos } 3410 1.1 christos /* fall through */ 3411 1.1 christos 3412 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24: 3413 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14: 3414 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN: 3415 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN: 3416 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info)) 3417 1.1 christos { 3418 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be 3419 1.1 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */ 3420 1.10 christos h->needs_plt = 1; 3421 1.10 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0)) 3422 1.10 christos return false; 3423 1.10 christos break; 3424 1.10 christos } 3425 1.10 christos 3426 1.10 christos dodyn: 3427 1.10 christos /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic 3428 1.10 christos relocations. At this point in linking we have read all 3429 1.10 christos the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not 3430 1.10 christos yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized 3431 1.10 christos symbol flags. In some cases we might be setting dynamic 3432 1.10 christos reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such. 3433 1.10 christos That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs 3434 1.10 christos work together with this code. */ 3435 1.1 christos if ((h != NULL 3436 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 3437 1.1 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info) 3438 1.1 christos && (h != NULL 3439 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root) 3440 1.1 christos : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS) 3441 1.1 christos && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))) 3442 1.1 christos { 3443 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 3444 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, 3445 1.1 christos "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to " 3446 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n", 3447 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string 3448 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>")); 3449 1.10 christos #endif 3450 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL) 3451 1.1 christos { 3452 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL) 3453 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd; 3454 1.1 christos 3455 1.1 christos sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section 3456 1.1 christos (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true); 3457 1.1 christos 3458 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL) 3459 1.3 christos return false; 3460 1.3 christos } 3461 1.3 christos 3462 1.10 christos /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of 3463 1.3 christos relocations we need for this symbol. */ 3464 1.3 christos if (h != NULL) 3465 1.3 christos { 3466 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p; 3467 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head; 3468 1.10 christos 3469 1.3 christos rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs; 3470 1.3 christos p = *rel_head; 3471 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec) 3472 1.3 christos { 3473 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p); 3474 1.3 christos if (p == NULL) 3475 1.3 christos return false; 3476 1.3 christos p->next = *rel_head; 3477 1.3 christos *rel_head = p; 3478 1.1 christos p->sec = sec; 3479 1.1 christos p->count = 0; 3480 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0; 3481 1.1 christos } 3482 1.1 christos p->count += 1; 3483 1.1 christos if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)) 3484 1.3 christos p->pc_count += 1; 3485 1.3 christos } 3486 1.10 christos else 3487 1.1 christos { 3488 1.1 christos /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too. 3489 1.1 christos We really need local syms available to do this 3490 1.1 christos easily. Oh well. */ 3491 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p; 3492 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head; 3493 1.1 christos bool is_ifunc; 3494 1.1 christos asection *s; 3495 1.3 christos void *vpp; 3496 1.10 christos 3497 1.3 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx); 3498 1.3 christos if (s == NULL) 3499 1.3 christos s = sec; 3500 1.3 christos 3501 1.3 christos vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; 3502 1.3 christos rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp; 3503 1.3 christos is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL; 3504 1.10 christos p = *rel_head; 3505 1.3 christos if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc) 3506 1.3 christos p = p->next; 3507 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc) 3508 1.3 christos { 3509 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p); 3510 1.3 christos if (p == NULL) 3511 1.3 christos return false; 3512 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head; 3513 1.1 christos *rel_head = p; 3514 1.1 christos p->sec = sec; 3515 1.1 christos p->ifunc = is_ifunc; 3516 1.1 christos p->count = 0; 3517 1.1 christos } 3518 1.1 christos p->count += 1; 3519 1.10 christos } 3520 1.1 christos } 3521 1.1 christos 3522 1.7 christos break; 3523 1.7 christos } 3524 1.10 christos } 3525 1.7 christos 3526 1.1 christos return true; 3527 1.7 christos } 3528 1.1 christos 3529 1.1 christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD 3531 1.10 christos and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */ 3532 1.10 christos bool 3533 1.10 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 3534 1.10 christos { 3535 1.10 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd; 3536 1.10 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs; 3537 1.10 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs; 3538 1.10 christos bool ret = true; 3539 1.10 christos bool warn_only; 3540 1.10 christos 3541 1.10 christos /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common 3542 1.1 christos libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant 3543 1.1 christos but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc 3544 1.1 christos typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library 3545 1.1 christos but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double. 3546 1.1 christos The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using 3547 1.1 christos object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility 3548 1.7 christos layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */ 3549 1.1 christos warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0; 3550 1.1 christos 3551 1.7 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU]; 3552 1.7 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU]; 3553 1.7 christos 3554 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP]; 3555 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP]; 3556 1.7 christos 3557 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i) 3558 1.7 christos { 3559 1.10 christos int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3; 3560 1.10 christos int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3; 3561 1.10 christos static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld; 3562 1.10 christos 3563 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0) 3564 1.10 christos ; 3565 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0) 3566 1.7 christos { 3567 1.7 christos if (!warn_only) 3568 1.7 christos { 3569 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL; 3570 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp; 3571 1.7 christos last_fp = ibfd; 3572 1.10 christos } 3573 1.7 christos } 3574 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2) 3575 1.7 christos { 3576 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3577 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3578 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"), 3579 1.7 christos last_fp, ibfd); 3580 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3581 1.7 christos } 3582 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2) 3583 1.7 christos { 3584 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3585 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3586 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"), 3587 1.7 christos ibfd, last_fp); 3588 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3589 1.7 christos } 3590 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3) 3591 1.7 christos { 3592 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3593 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3594 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, " 3595 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd); 3596 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3597 1.7 christos } 3598 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1) 3599 1.7 christos { 3600 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3601 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3602 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, " 3603 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp); 3604 1.7 christos ret = warn_only; 3605 1.10 christos } 3606 1.10 christos 3607 1.10 christos in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc; 3608 1.10 christos out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc; 3609 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0) 3610 1.10 christos ; 3611 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0) 3612 1.7 christos { 3613 1.7 christos if (!warn_only) 3614 1.7 christos { 3615 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL; 3616 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp; 3617 1.7 christos last_ld = ibfd; 3618 1.10 christos } 3619 1.7 christos } 3620 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4) 3621 1.7 christos { 3622 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3623 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3624 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, " 3625 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld); 3626 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3627 1.7 christos } 3628 1.7 christos else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4) 3629 1.7 christos { 3630 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3631 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3632 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, " 3633 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd); 3634 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3635 1.7 christos } 3636 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4) 3637 1.7 christos { 3638 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3639 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3640 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, " 3641 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd); 3642 1.10 christos ret = warn_only; 3643 1.7 christos } 3644 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4) 3645 1.7 christos { 3646 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3647 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3648 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, " 3649 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld); 3650 1.1 christos ret = warn_only; 3651 1.7 christos } 3652 1.7 christos } 3653 1.7 christos 3654 1.7 christos if (!ret) 3655 1.7 christos { 3656 1.10 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR; 3657 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 3658 1.7 christos } 3659 1.7 christos return ret; 3660 1.7 christos } 3661 1.7 christos 3662 1.10 christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if 3663 1.7 christos there are conflicting attributes. */ 3664 1.7 christos static bool 3665 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 3666 1.7 christos { 3667 1.7 christos bfd *obfd; 3668 1.7 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs; 3669 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs; 3670 1.1 christos bool ret; 3671 1.1 christos 3672 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info)) 3673 1.1 christos return false; 3674 1.1 christos 3675 1.10 christos obfd = info->output_bfd; 3676 1.1 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU]; 3677 1.1 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU]; 3678 1.7 christos 3679 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and 3680 1.7 christos merge non-conflicting ones. */ 3681 1.1 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector]; 3682 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector]; 3683 1.7 christos ret = true; 3684 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i) 3685 1.1 christos { 3686 1.7 christos int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3; 3687 1.7 christos int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3; 3688 1.7 christos static bfd *last_vec; 3689 1.1 christos 3690 1.1 christos if (in_vec == 0) 3691 1.1 christos ; 3692 1.1 christos else if (out_vec == 0) 3693 1.1 christos { 3694 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL; 3695 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec; 3696 1.1 christos last_vec = ibfd; 3697 1.7 christos } 3698 1.7 christos /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE 3699 1.7 christos without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack 3700 1.7 christos alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are 3701 1.7 christos not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this 3702 1.7 christos case too. */ 3703 1.7 christos else if (in_vec == 1) 3704 1.7 christos ; 3705 1.7 christos else if (out_vec == 1) 3706 1.7 christos { 3707 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL; 3708 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec; 3709 1.7 christos last_vec = ibfd; 3710 1.10 christos } 3711 1.7 christos else if (out_vec < in_vec) 3712 1.7 christos { 3713 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3714 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3715 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"), 3716 1.7 christos last_vec, ibfd); 3717 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR; 3718 1.7 christos ret = false; 3719 1.10 christos } 3720 1.7 christos else if (out_vec > in_vec) 3721 1.1 christos { 3722 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 3723 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3724 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"), 3725 1.1 christos ibfd, last_vec); 3726 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR; 3727 1.1 christos ret = false; 3728 1.1 christos } 3729 1.7 christos } 3730 1.7 christos 3731 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes 3732 1.7 christos and merge non-conflicting ones. */ 3733 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return]; 3734 1.1 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return]; 3735 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i) 3736 1.7 christos { 3737 1.7 christos int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3; 3738 1.7 christos int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3; 3739 1.7 christos static bfd *last_struct; 3740 1.7 christos 3741 1.7 christos if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3) 3742 1.7 christos ; 3743 1.7 christos else if (out_struct == 0) 3744 1.7 christos { 3745 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL; 3746 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_struct; 3747 1.7 christos last_struct = ibfd; 3748 1.10 christos } 3749 1.7 christos else if (out_struct < in_struct) 3750 1.7 christos { 3751 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3752 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3753 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, " 3754 1.7 christos "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd); 3755 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR; 3756 1.7 christos ret = false; 3757 1.10 christos } 3758 1.7 christos else if (out_struct > in_struct) 3759 1.7 christos { 3760 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3761 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3762 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, " 3763 1.10 christos "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct); 3764 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR; 3765 1.1 christos ret = false; 3766 1.1 christos } 3767 1.7 christos } 3768 1.1 christos if (!ret) 3769 1.1 christos { 3770 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 3771 1.1 christos return false; 3772 1.1 christos } 3773 1.10 christos 3774 1.7 christos /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */ 3775 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info); 3776 1.7 christos } 3777 1.1 christos 3778 1.1 christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output 3779 1.10 christos object file when linking. */ 3780 1.1 christos 3781 1.1 christos static bool 3782 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 3783 1.1 christos { 3784 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd; 3785 1.7 christos flagword old_flags; 3786 1.10 christos flagword new_flags; 3787 1.1 christos bool error; 3788 1.7 christos 3789 1.10 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd)) 3790 1.10 christos return true; 3791 1.10 christos 3792 1.10 christos /* Check if we have the same endianness. */ 3793 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info)) 3794 1.1 christos return false; 3795 1.1 christos 3796 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info)) 3797 1.1 christos return false; 3798 1.1 christos 3799 1.10 christos if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0) 3800 1.1 christos return true; 3801 1.1 christos 3802 1.1 christos new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags; 3803 1.1 christos old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags; 3804 1.1 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd)) 3805 1.1 christos { 3806 1.1 christos /* First call, no flags set. */ 3807 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = true; 3808 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags; 3809 1.1 christos } 3810 1.1 christos 3811 1.1 christos /* Compatible flags are ok. */ 3812 1.10 christos else if (new_flags == old_flags) 3813 1.1 christos ; 3814 1.1 christos 3815 1.1 christos /* Incompatible flags. */ 3816 1.10 christos else 3817 1.7 christos { 3818 1.7 christos /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib 3819 1.1 christos to be linked with either. */ 3820 1.1 christos error = false; 3821 1.1 christos if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0 3822 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0) 3823 1.1 christos { 3824 1.10 christos error = true; 3825 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3826 1.7 christos (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with " 3827 1.1 christos "modules compiled normally"), ibfd); 3828 1.1 christos } 3829 1.1 christos else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0 3830 1.1 christos && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0) 3831 1.1 christos { 3832 1.1 christos error = true; 3833 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 3834 1.1 christos (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with " 3835 1.1 christos "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd); 3836 1.1 christos } 3837 1.1 christos 3838 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */ 3839 1.1 christos if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) 3840 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB; 3841 1.1 christos 3842 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib, 3843 1.1 christos but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */ 3844 1.1 christos if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB) 3845 1.1 christos && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)) 3846 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))) 3847 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE; 3848 1.1 christos 3849 1.1 christos /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if 3850 1.1 christos any module uses it. */ 3851 1.10 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB); 3852 1.7 christos 3853 1.7 christos new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB); 3854 1.7 christos old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB); 3855 1.7 christos 3856 1.7 christos /* Warn about any other mismatches. */ 3857 1.1 christos if (new_flags != old_flags) 3858 1.1 christos { 3859 1.1 christos error = true; 3860 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 3861 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3862 1.10 christos (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields " 3863 1.1 christos "than previous modules (%#x)"), 3864 1.1 christos ibfd, new_flags, old_flags); 3865 1.1 christos } 3866 1.10 christos 3867 1.1 christos if (error) 3868 1.1 christos { 3869 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 3870 1.7 christos return false; 3871 1.7 christos } 3872 1.7 christos } 3873 1.7 christos 3874 1.3 christos return true; 3875 1.7 christos } 3876 1.10 christos 3877 1.7 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type 3878 1.9 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd, 3879 1.7 christos asection *input_section, 3880 1.10 christos unsigned long offset, 3881 1.10 christos bfd_byte *loc, 3882 1.7 christos bfd_vma value, 3883 1.9 christos split16_format_type split16_format, 3884 1.7 christos bool fixup) 3885 1.7 christos { 3886 1.7 christos unsigned int insn, opcode; 3887 1.7 christos 3888 1.7 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4)) 3889 1.7 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 3890 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc); 3891 1.7 christos opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK; 3892 1.7 christos if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN 3893 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN 3894 1.7 christos || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN 3895 1.7 christos || opcode == E_LIS_INSN 3896 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN) 3897 1.7 christos { 3898 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16a_type) 3899 1.7 christos { 3900 1.7 christos if (fixup) 3901 1.7 christos split16_format = split16a_type; 3902 1.7 christos else 3903 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler 3904 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3905 1.7 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"), 3906 1.7 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode); 3907 1.7 christos } 3908 1.7 christos } 3909 1.7 christos else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN 3910 1.7 christos || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN 3911 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN 3912 1.7 christos || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN 3913 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN 3914 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN 3915 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN) 3916 1.7 christos { 3917 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16d_type) 3918 1.7 christos { 3919 1.7 christos if (fixup) 3920 1.9 christos split16_format = split16d_type; 3921 1.9 christos else 3922 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler 3923 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 3924 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"), 3925 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode); 3926 1.9 christos } 3927 1.9 christos } 3928 1.9 christos if (split16_format == split16a_type) 3929 1.9 christos { 3930 1.9 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff); 3931 1.9 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5; 3932 1.9 christos if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN) 3933 1.9 christos { 3934 1.9 christos /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */ 3935 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5); 3936 1.7 christos insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5; 3937 1.7 christos } 3938 1.10 christos } 3939 1.7 christos else 3940 1.1 christos { 3941 1.7 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff); 3942 1.7 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10; 3943 1.1 christos } 3944 1.7 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff; 3945 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc); 3946 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_ok; 3947 1.7 christos } 3948 1.7 christos 3949 1.7 christos static void 3950 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value) 3951 1.7 christos { 3952 1.7 christos unsigned int insn; 3953 1.3 christos 3954 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc); 3955 1.1 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */ 3956 1.1 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */ 3957 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5; 3958 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */ 3959 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5; 3960 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */ 3961 1.1 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff; 3962 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc); 3963 1.1 christos } 3964 1.1 christos 3965 1.1 christos 3966 1.1 christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately. 3968 1.1 christos Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */ 3969 1.1 christos int 3970 1.1 christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 3971 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 3972 1.1 christos { 3973 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 3974 1.1 christos flagword flags; 3975 1.3 christos 3976 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 3977 1.1 christos 3978 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET) 3979 1.1 christos { 3980 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 3981 1.1 christos 3982 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD) 3983 1.7 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD; 3984 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info) 3985 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 3986 1.1 christos && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount", 3987 1.1 christos false, false, true)) != NULL 3988 1.1 christos && (h->type == STT_FUNC 3989 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt) 3990 1.1 christos && h->ref_regular 3991 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h) 3992 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))) 3993 1.1 christos { 3994 1.3 christos /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with 3995 1.1 christos secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a 3996 1.1 christos function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs 3997 1.1 christos r30 to be set up. */ 3998 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD; 3999 1.1 christos } 4000 1.1 christos else 4001 1.1 christos { 4002 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd; 4003 1.1 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style; 4004 1.1 christos 4005 1.1 christos /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs. 4006 1.1 christos Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls 4007 1.1 christos without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given 4008 1.1 christos --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */ 4009 1.1 christos if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET) 4010 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD; 4011 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 4012 1.1 christos if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd)) 4013 1.1 christos { 4014 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16) 4015 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_NEW; 4016 1.1 christos else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call) 4017 1.11 christos { 4018 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD; 4019 1.11 christos htab->old_bfd = ibfd; 4020 1.11 christos break; 4021 1.11 christos } 4022 1.11 christos } 4023 1.11 christos htab->plt_type = plt_type; 4024 1.11 christos } 4025 1.11 christos } 4026 1.11 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD) 4027 1.11 christos { 4028 1.11 christos if (!info->user_warn_rwx_segments) 4029 1.11 christos info->no_warn_rwx_segments = 1; 4030 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW 4031 1.1 christos || (htab->params->plt_style != PLT_OLD 4032 1.1 christos && !info->no_warn_rwx_segments)) 4033 1.1 christos { 4034 1.1 christos if (htab->old_bfd != NULL) 4035 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd); 4036 1.1 christos else 4037 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling")); 4038 1.1 christos } 4039 1.1 christos } 4040 1.7 christos 4041 1.9 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS); 4042 1.1 christos 4043 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW) 4044 1.1 christos { 4045 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 4046 1.9 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 4047 1.1 christos 4048 1.1 christos /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */ 4049 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL 4050 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags)) 4051 1.1 christos return -1; 4052 1.1 christos 4053 1.9 christos /* The new GOT is not executable. */ 4054 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL 4055 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags)) 4056 1.1 christos return -1; 4057 1.1 christos } 4058 1.1 christos else 4059 1.1 christos { 4060 1.1 christos /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */ 4061 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL 4062 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0)) 4063 1.1 christos return -1; 4064 1.1 christos } 4065 1.1 christos return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW; 4066 1.1 christos } 4067 1.1 christos 4068 1.1 christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given 4070 1.1 christos relocation. */ 4071 1.1 christos 4072 1.1 christos static asection * 4073 1.1 christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec, 4074 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 4075 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, 4076 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 4077 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym) 4078 1.1 christos { 4079 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 4080 1.10 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) 4081 1.7 christos { 4082 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT: 4083 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY: 4084 1.7 christos return NULL; 4085 1.7 christos } 4086 1.7 christos 4087 1.7 christos return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym); 4088 1.1 christos } 4089 1.7 christos 4090 1.1 christos static bool 4091 1.7 christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp, 4092 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **symp, 4093 1.7 christos asection **symsecp, 4094 1.7 christos unsigned char **tls_maskp, 4095 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp, 4096 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx, 4097 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd) 4098 1.7 christos { 4099 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 4100 1.1 christos 4101 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info) 4102 1.7 christos { 4103 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd); 4104 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 4105 1.7 christos 4106 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 4107 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 4108 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 4109 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 4110 1.7 christos 4111 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL) 4112 1.7 christos *hp = h; 4113 1.7 christos 4114 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL) 4115 1.1 christos *symp = NULL; 4116 1.7 christos 4117 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL) 4118 1.7 christos { 4119 1.7 christos asection *symsec = NULL; 4120 1.7 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 4121 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) 4122 1.7 christos symsec = h->root.u.def.section; 4123 1.1 christos *symsecp = symsec; 4124 1.7 christos } 4125 1.7 christos 4126 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL) 4127 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask; 4128 1.7 christos } 4129 1.7 christos else 4130 1.7 christos { 4131 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 4132 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp; 4133 1.7 christos 4134 1.1 christos if (locsyms == NULL) 4135 1.7 christos { 4136 1.1 christos locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents; 4137 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL) 4138 1.7 christos locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, 4139 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->sh_info, 4140 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL); 4141 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL) 4142 1.1 christos return false; 4143 1.7 christos *locsymsp = locsyms; 4144 1.7 christos } 4145 1.1 christos sym = locsyms + r_symndx; 4146 1.7 christos 4147 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL) 4148 1.7 christos *hp = NULL; 4149 1.7 christos 4150 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL) 4151 1.7 christos *symp = sym; 4152 1.7 christos 4153 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL) 4154 1.1 christos *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx); 4155 1.7 christos 4156 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL) 4157 1.7 christos { 4158 1.7 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got; 4159 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_mask; 4160 1.1 christos 4161 1.7 christos tls_mask = NULL; 4162 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd); 4163 1.1 christos if (local_got != NULL) 4164 1.10 christos { 4165 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) 4166 1.1 christos (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 4167 1.7 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) 4168 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 4169 1.1 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx]; 4170 1.10 christos } 4171 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = tls_mask; 4172 1.1 christos } 4173 1.1 christos } 4174 1.7 christos return true; 4175 1.7 christos } 4176 1.7 christos 4177 1.1 christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally 4179 1.7 christos defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */ 4180 1.10 christos 4181 1.7 christos bool 4182 1.7 christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info) 4183 1.7 christos { 4184 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 4185 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd; 4186 1.7 christos asection *sec; 4187 1.7 christos bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit; 4188 1.7 christos 4189 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 4190 1.7 christos if (htab == NULL) 4191 1.7 christos return false; 4192 1.7 christos 4193 1.7 christos /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is 4194 1.7 christos reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added 4195 1.7 christos between the call and its destination. */ 4196 1.3 christos limit = 0x1e00000; 4197 1.7 christos low_vma = -1; 4198 1.7 christos high_vma = 0; 4199 1.7 christos for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) 4200 1.7 christos if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) 4201 1.7 christos { 4202 1.7 christos if (low_vma > sec->vma) 4203 1.10 christos low_vma = sec->vma; 4204 1.7 christos if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size) 4205 1.7 christos high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size; 4206 1.7 christos } 4207 1.7 christos 4208 1.7 christos /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can 4209 1.7 christos convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol 4210 1.7 christos is local. */ 4211 1.7 christos if (high_vma - low_vma < limit) 4212 1.7 christos { 4213 1.7 christos htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1; 4214 1.7 christos return true; 4215 1.7 christos } 4216 1.7 christos 4217 1.7 christos /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct 4218 1.7 christos call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable 4219 1.7 christos the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that 4220 1.7 christos this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this 4221 1.7 christos will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a 4222 1.7 christos particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The 4223 1.7 christos difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the 4224 1.7 christos linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a 4225 1.7 christos particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct 4226 1.7 christos call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in 4227 1.7 christos the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs 4228 1.7 christos together except their symbol. */ 4229 1.7 christos 4230 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 4231 1.7 christos { 4232 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 4233 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms; 4234 1.7 christos 4235 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd)) 4236 1.7 christos continue; 4237 1.7 christos 4238 1.7 christos local_syms = NULL; 4239 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 4240 1.10 christos 4241 1.7 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) 4242 1.7 christos if (sec->has_pltcall 4243 1.8 rin && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section)) 4244 1.7 christos { 4245 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend; 4246 1.7 christos 4247 1.7 christos /* Read the relocations. */ 4248 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, 4249 1.7 christos info->keep_memory); 4250 1.7 christos if (relstart == NULL) 4251 1.7 christos return false; 4252 1.7 christos 4253 1.7 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count; 4254 1.7 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++) 4255 1.7 christos { 4256 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 4257 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx; 4258 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec; 4259 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 4260 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 4261 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_maskp; 4262 1.10 christos 4263 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info); 4264 1.10 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL) 4265 1.7 christos continue; 4266 1.7 christos 4267 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 4268 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms, 4269 1.7 christos r_symndx, ibfd)) 4270 1.7 christos { 4271 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4272 1.7 christos free (relstart); 4273 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms) 4274 1.7 christos free (local_syms); 4275 1.7 christos return false; 4276 1.7 christos } 4277 1.7 christos 4278 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL) 4279 1.7 christos { 4280 1.7 christos bfd_vma from, to; 4281 1.7 christos if (h != NULL) 4282 1.7 christos to = h->root.u.def.value; 4283 1.7 christos else 4284 1.7 christos to = sym->st_value; 4285 1.7 christos to += (rel->r_addend 4286 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_offset 4287 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_section->vma); 4288 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset 4289 1.7 christos + sec->output_offset 4290 1.7 christos + sec->output_section->vma); 4291 1.7 christos if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit) 4292 1.7 christos *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP; 4293 1.7 christos } 4294 1.7 christos } 4295 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4296 1.7 christos free (relstart); 4297 1.7 christos } 4298 1.10 christos 4299 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL 4300 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms) 4301 1.7 christos { 4302 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory) 4303 1.7 christos free (local_syms); 4304 1.7 christos else 4305 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms; 4306 1.7 christos } 4307 1.7 christos } 4308 1.7 christos 4309 1.7 christos return true; 4310 1.7 christos } 4311 1.10 christos 4312 1.7 christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the 4313 1.10 christos generic ELF tls_setup function. */ 4314 1.7 christos 4315 1.7 christos asection * 4316 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 4317 1.1 christos { 4318 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 4319 1.10 christos 4320 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 4321 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr", 4322 1.1 christos false, false, true); 4323 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW) 4324 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true; 4325 1.1 christos 4326 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt) 4327 1.1 christos { 4328 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga; 4329 1.1 christos opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt", 4330 1.1 christos false, false, true); 4331 1.1 christos if (opt != NULL 4332 1.1 christos && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 4333 1.1 christos || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)) 4334 1.7 christos { 4335 1.1 christos /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub, 4336 1.1 christos signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll 4337 1.1 christos be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then 4338 1.1 christos make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */ 4339 1.1 christos tga = htab->tls_get_addr; 4340 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 4341 1.1 christos && tga != NULL 4342 1.1 christos && (tga->type == STT_FUNC 4343 1.1 christos || tga->needs_plt) 4344 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga) 4345 1.7 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga))) 4346 1.1 christos { 4347 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 4348 1.1 christos for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 4349 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0) 4350 1.1 christos break; 4351 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL) 4352 1.1 christos { 4353 1.12 christos tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect; 4354 1.1 christos tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root; 4355 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga); 4356 1.1 christos opt->mark = 1; 4357 1.1 christos if (opt->dynindx != -1) 4358 1.1 christos { 4359 1.1 christos /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */ 4360 1.10 christos opt->dynindx = -1; 4361 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr, 4362 1.1 christos opt->dynstr_index); 4363 1.7 christos if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt)) 4364 1.7 christos return NULL; 4365 1.1 christos } 4366 1.7 christos htab->tls_get_addr = opt; 4367 1.7 christos } 4368 1.1 christos } 4369 1.1 christos } 4370 1.1 christos else 4371 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true; 4372 1.1 christos } 4373 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW 4374 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL 4375 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL) 4376 1.10 christos { 4377 1.1 christos elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS; 4378 1.1 christos elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE; 4379 1.1 christos } 4380 1.1 christos 4381 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info); 4382 1.1 christos } 4383 1.1 christos 4384 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching 4385 1.1 christos HASH. */ 4386 1.1 christos 4387 1.1 christos static bool 4388 1.1 christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd, 4389 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, 4390 1.1 christos const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash) 4391 1.1 christos { 4392 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 4393 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info); 4394 1.1 christos unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 4395 1.10 christos 4396 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type)) 4397 1.10 christos { 4398 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd); 4399 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 4400 1.1 christos 4401 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 4402 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 4403 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 4404 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 4405 1.1 christos if (h == hash) 4406 1.1 christos return true; 4407 1.1 christos } 4408 1.1 christos return false; 4409 1.1 christos } 4410 1.1 christos 4411 1.1 christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization 4412 1.3 christos opportunities. */ 4413 1.10 christos 4414 1.1 christos bool 4415 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 4416 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 4417 1.10 christos { 4418 1.10 christos bfd *ibfd; 4419 1.10 christos asection *sec; 4420 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 4421 1.1 christos int pass; 4422 1.1 christos 4423 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info)) 4424 1.1 christos return true; 4425 1.1 christos 4426 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 4427 1.1 christos if (htab == NULL) 4428 1.3 christos return false; 4429 1.1 christos 4430 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 1; 4431 1.1 christos 4432 1.1 christos /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls 4433 1.1 christos relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed 4434 1.1 christos followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls 4435 1.1 christos optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to 4436 1.1 christos notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and 4437 1.1 christos adjust got and plt refcounts. */ 4438 1.1 christos for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass) 4439 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 4440 1.1 christos { 4441 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 4442 1.1 christos asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2"); 4443 1.10 christos 4444 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) 4445 1.1 christos if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section)) 4446 1.1 christos { 4447 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend; 4448 1.1 christos int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0; 4449 1.1 christos 4450 1.1 christos /* Read the relocations. */ 4451 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, 4452 1.7 christos info->keep_memory); 4453 1.10 christos if (relstart == NULL) 4454 1.1 christos return false; 4455 1.1 christos 4456 1.1 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count; 4457 1.1 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++) 4458 1.1 christos { 4459 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 4460 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx; 4461 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL; 4462 1.1 christos unsigned char *tls_mask; 4463 1.1 christos unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear; 4464 1.1 christos bool is_local; 4465 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *got_count; 4466 1.1 christos 4467 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 4468 1.9 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info) 4469 1.1 christos { 4470 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 4471 1.1 christos 4472 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd); 4473 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 4474 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 4475 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 4476 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 4477 1.9 christos } 4478 1.1 christos 4479 1.1 christos is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h); 4480 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info); 4481 1.1 christos /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls 4482 1.1 christos without marker relocs, then check that each 4483 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc 4484 1.1 christos that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg 4485 1.1 christos setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup 4486 1.1 christos relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */ 4487 1.1 christos if (pass == 0 4488 1.10 christos && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr 4489 1.1 christos && h != NULL 4490 1.1 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr 4491 1.1 christos && !expecting_tls_get_addr 4492 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)) 4493 1.1 christos { 4494 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, " 4495 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n", 4496 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset); 4497 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4498 1.1 christos free (relstart); 4499 1.1 christos return true; 4500 1.1 christos } 4501 1.1 christos 4502 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 0; 4503 1.1 christos switch (r_type) 4504 1.1 christos { 4505 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: 4506 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: 4507 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1; 4508 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 4509 1.1 christos 4510 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: 4511 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: 4512 1.1 christos /* These relocs should never be against a symbol 4513 1.1 christos defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if 4514 1.1 christos that turns out to be the case. */ 4515 1.7 christos if (!is_local) 4516 1.1 christos continue; 4517 1.1 christos 4518 1.1 christos /* LD -> LE */ 4519 1.1 christos tls_set = 0; 4520 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_LD; 4521 1.1 christos break; 4522 1.1 christos 4523 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: 4524 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: 4525 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1; 4526 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 4527 1.1 christos 4528 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: 4529 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: 4530 1.1 christos if (is_local) 4531 1.1 christos /* GD -> LE */ 4532 1.1 christos tls_set = 0; 4533 1.1 christos else 4534 1.1 christos /* GD -> IE */ 4535 1.1 christos tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE; 4536 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_GD; 4537 1.1 christos break; 4538 1.1 christos 4539 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: 4540 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: 4541 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: 4542 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: 4543 1.9 christos if (is_local) 4544 1.9 christos { 4545 1.9 christos /* IE -> LE */ 4546 1.1 christos tls_set = 0; 4547 1.7 christos tls_clear = TLS_TPREL; 4548 1.7 christos break; 4549 1.7 christos } 4550 1.7 christos else 4551 1.7 christos continue; 4552 1.7 christos 4553 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD: 4554 1.7 christos if (!is_local) 4555 1.7 christos continue; 4556 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */ 4557 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD: 4558 1.7 christos if (rel + 1 < relend 4559 1.7 christos && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info))) 4560 1.7 christos { 4561 1.7 christos if (pass != 0 4562 1.7 christos && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ) 4563 1.7 christos { 4564 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info); 4565 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info); 4566 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info) 4567 1.7 christos { 4568 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 4569 1.7 christos 4570 1.7 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd); 4571 1.7 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 4572 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 4573 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 4574 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 4575 1.7 christos if (h != NULL) 4576 1.7 christos { 4577 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent = NULL; 4578 1.7 christos bfd_vma addend = 0; 4579 1.7 christos 4580 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 4581 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend; 4582 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, 4583 1.1 christos got2, addend); 4584 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL 4585 1.1 christos && ent->plt.refcount > 0) 4586 1.10 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1; 4587 1.10 christos } 4588 1.10 christos } 4589 1.10 christos } 4590 1.10 christos continue; 4591 1.10 christos } 4592 1.10 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 2; 4593 1.10 christos tls_set = 0; 4594 1.10 christos tls_clear = 0; 4595 1.10 christos break; 4596 1.10 christos 4597 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 4598 1.10 christos if (pass == 0) 4599 1.10 christos { 4600 1.10 christos unsigned char buf[4]; 4601 1.10 christos unsigned int insn; 4602 1.10 christos bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3; 4603 1.10 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, 4604 1.10 christos off, 4)) 4605 1.10 christos { 4606 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4607 1.10 christos free (relstart); 4608 1.10 christos return false; 4609 1.10 christos } 4610 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf); 4611 1.10 christos /* addis rt,2,imm */ 4612 1.10 christos if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16)) 4613 1.10 christos != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16))) 4614 1.10 christos { 4615 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 4616 1.10 christos info->callbacks->minfo 4617 1.1 christos (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"), 4618 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn); 4619 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0; 4620 1.1 christos } 4621 1.1 christos } 4622 1.1 christos continue; 4623 1.1 christos 4624 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI: 4625 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0; 4626 1.1 christos continue; 4627 1.1 christos 4628 1.1 christos default: 4629 1.1 christos continue; 4630 1.1 christos } 4631 1.1 christos 4632 1.1 christos if (pass == 0) 4633 1.1 christos { 4634 1.1 christos if (!expecting_tls_get_addr 4635 1.1 christos || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr) 4636 1.1 christos continue; 4637 1.1 christos 4638 1.1 christos if (rel + 1 < relend 4639 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1, 4640 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr)) 4641 1.10 christos continue; 4642 1.1 christos 4643 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We 4644 1.1 christos could just mark this symbol to exclude it 4645 1.1 christos from tls optimization but it's safer to skip 4646 1.1 christos the entire optimization. */ 4647 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, " 4648 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n"), 4649 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset); 4650 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4651 1.1 christos free (relstart); 4652 1.1 christos return true; 4653 1.7 christos } 4654 1.1 christos 4655 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 4656 1.1 christos { 4657 1.1 christos tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask; 4658 1.1 christos got_count = &h->got.refcount; 4659 1.1 christos } 4660 1.7 christos else 4661 1.7 christos { 4662 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs; 4663 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 4664 1.1 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks; 4665 1.1 christos 4666 1.7 christos lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd); 4667 1.7 christos if (lgot_refs == NULL) 4668 1.7 christos abort (); 4669 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) 4670 1.7 christos (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 4671 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) 4672 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 4673 1.7 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx]; 4674 1.9 christos got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx]; 4675 1.7 christos } 4676 1.7 christos 4677 1.7 christos /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls 4678 1.7 christos without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't 4679 1.9 christos found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a 4680 1.7 christos marker for this symbol, then we either have a 4681 1.7 christos broken object file or an -mlongcall style 4682 1.7 christos indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker. 4683 1.7 christos Disable optimization in this case. */ 4684 1.7 christos if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0 4685 1.7 christos && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr 4686 1.7 christos && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)) 4687 1.7 christos != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))) 4688 1.7 christos continue; 4689 1.7 christos 4690 1.7 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr) 4691 1.7 christos { 4692 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 4693 1.9 christos bfd_vma addend = 0; 4694 1.9 christos 4695 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 4696 1.1 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24 4697 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL)) 4698 1.1 christos addend = rel[1].r_addend; 4699 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist, 4700 1.1 christos got2, addend); 4701 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0) 4702 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1; 4703 1.1 christos } 4704 1.1 christos if (tls_clear == 0) 4705 1.1 christos continue; 4706 1.1 christos 4707 1.1 christos if (tls_set == 0) 4708 1.1 christos { 4709 1.1 christos /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */ 4710 1.1 christos if (*got_count > 0) 4711 1.10 christos *got_count -= 1; 4712 1.1 christos } 4713 1.1 christos 4714 1.7 christos *tls_mask |= tls_set; 4715 1.7 christos *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear; 4716 1.7 christos } 4717 1.7 christos 4718 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart) 4719 1.7 christos free (relstart); 4720 1.7 christos } 4721 1.7 christos } 4722 1.7 christos return true; 4723 1.7 christos } 4724 1.10 christos 4725 1.10 christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak 4727 1.7 christos aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after 4728 1.7 christos size_dynamic_sections. */ 4729 1.10 christos 4730 1.7 christos static bool 4731 1.7 christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 4732 1.7 christos { 4733 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h); 4734 1.10 christos do 4735 1.7 christos { 4736 1.7 christos if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf)) 4737 1.7 christos return true; 4738 1.7 christos eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias); 4739 1.10 christos } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h); 4740 1.7 christos 4741 1.10 christos return false; 4742 1.10 christos } 4743 1.1 christos 4744 1.1 christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */ 4745 1.1 christos 4746 1.1 christos static bool 4747 1.1 christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 4748 1.1 christos { 4749 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p; 4750 1.1 christos 4751 1.10 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next) 4752 1.1 christos if (p->pc_count != 0) 4753 1.1 christos return true; 4754 1.1 christos return false; 4755 1.1 christos } 4756 1.1 christos 4757 1.1 christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a 4758 1.1 christos regular object. The current definition is in some section of the 4759 1.1 christos dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to 4760 1.1 christos change the definition to something the rest of the link can 4761 1.1 christos understand. */ 4762 1.1 christos 4763 1.1 christos static bool 4764 1.1 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, 4765 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 4766 1.1 christos { 4767 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 4768 1.7 christos asection *s; 4769 1.1 christos 4770 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 4771 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n", 4772 1.1 christos h->root.root.string); 4773 1.1 christos #endif 4774 1.1 christos 4775 1.1 christos /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */ 4776 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 4777 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL 4778 1.10 christos && (h->needs_plt 4779 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC 4780 1.7 christos || h->is_weakalias 4781 1.7 christos || (h->def_dynamic 4782 1.7 christos && h->ref_regular 4783 1.10 christos && !h->def_regular))); 4784 1.7 christos 4785 1.1 christos /* Deal with function syms. */ 4786 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_FUNC 4787 1.1 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC 4788 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt) 4789 1.1 christos { 4790 1.1 christos bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h) 4791 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)); 4792 1.1 christos /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a 4793 1.7 christos function symbol is local. */ 4794 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local) 4795 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 4796 1.7 christos 4797 1.1 christos /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that 4798 1.1 christos won't need a .plt entry. */ 4799 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 4800 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 4801 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0) 4802 1.1 christos break; 4803 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL 4804 1.1 christos || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC 4805 1.1 christos && local 4806 1.1 christos && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt 4807 1.1 christos || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask 4808 1.1 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP))) 4809 1.1 christos { 4810 1.3 christos /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when: 4811 1.1 christos 4812 1.1 christos 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry 4813 1.1 christos can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case, 4814 1.3 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called. 4815 1.3 christos 4816 1.3 christos 2. GC has rendered the entry unused. 4817 1.7 christos 4818 1.7 christos 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol 4819 1.7 christos will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */ 4820 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL; 4821 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 0; 4822 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0; 4823 1.7 christos } 4824 1.7 christos else 4825 1.7 christos { 4826 1.7 christos /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section 4827 1.10 christos doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the 4828 1.3 christos executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can 4829 1.10 christos be used instead, giving better runtime performance. 4830 1.3 christos (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce 4831 1.3 christos through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic 4832 1.7 christos reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the 4833 1.7 christos resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather 4834 1.7 christos than link time. */ 4835 1.7 christos if ((h->pointer_equality_needed 4836 1.7 christos || (h->non_got_ref 4837 1.7 christos && !h->ref_regular_nonweak 4838 1.7 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))) 4839 1.7 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks 4840 1.10 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs 4841 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h)) 4842 1.3 christos { 4843 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0; 4844 1.10 christos /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol 4845 1.1 christos isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */ 4846 1.1 christos if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC) 4847 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL; 4848 1.1 christos } 4849 1.1 christos else if (!bfd_link_pic (info)) 4850 1.1 christos /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the 4851 1.1 christos plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */ 4852 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 4853 1.1 christos } 4854 1.7 christos h->protected_def = 0; 4855 1.7 christos /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */ 4856 1.7 christos return true; 4857 1.7 christos } 4858 1.7 christos else 4859 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL; 4860 1.7 christos 4861 1.10 christos /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the 4862 1.10 christos processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the 4863 1.1 christos real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */ 4864 1.1 christos if (h->is_weakalias) 4865 1.1 christos { 4866 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h); 4867 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined); 4868 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section; 4869 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value; 4870 1.1 christos if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss 4871 1.1 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro 4872 1.3 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss) 4873 1.3 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 4874 1.3 christos return true; 4875 1.10 christos } 4876 1.3 christos 4877 1.1 christos /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which 4878 1.1 christos is not a function. */ 4879 1.1 christos 4880 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the 4881 1.3 christos only references to the symbol are via the global offset table. 4882 1.3 christos For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will 4883 1.10 christos be handled correctly by relocate_section. */ 4884 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 4885 1.3 christos { 4886 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0; 4887 1.3 christos return true; 4888 1.3 christos } 4889 1.3 christos 4890 1.3 christos /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the 4891 1.3 christos GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */ 4892 1.3 christos if (!h->non_got_ref) 4893 1.3 christos { 4894 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0; 4895 1.3 christos return true; 4896 1.3 christos } 4897 1.3 christos 4898 1.10 christos /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in 4899 1.3 christos .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected 4900 1.3 christos definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations 4901 1.3 christos are preferable to an incorrect program. */ 4902 1.3 christos if (h->protected_def) 4903 1.10 christos { 4904 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 4905 1.7 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha 4906 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo 4907 1.1 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0 4908 1.1 christos && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1) 4909 1.1 christos htab->params->pic_fixup = 1; 4910 1.1 christos return true; 4911 1.1 christos } 4912 1.1 christos 4913 1.10 christos /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */ 4914 1.1 christos if (info->nocopyreloc) 4915 1.7 christos return true; 4916 1.10 christos 4917 1.1 christos /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then 4918 1.1 christos we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc. 4919 1.1 christos We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This 4920 1.1 christos doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic 4921 1.1 christos relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an 4922 1.1 christos executable. */ 4923 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 4924 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs 4925 1.1 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks 4926 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular 4927 1.1 christos && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h)) 4928 1.1 christos return true; 4929 1.1 christos 4930 1.1 christos /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will 4931 1.1 christos become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be 4932 1.7 christos an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic 4933 1.7 christos object will contain position independent code, so all references 4934 1.1 christos from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global 4935 1.7 christos offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to 4936 1.1 christos determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so 4937 1.1 christos both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the 4938 1.1 christos same memory location for the variable. 4939 1.1 christos 4940 1.1 christos Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we 4941 1.1 christos must instead allocate it in .sbss. */ 4942 1.7 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs) 4943 1.7 christos s = htab->dynsbss; 4944 1.7 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0) 4945 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sdynrelro; 4946 1.1 christos else 4947 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sdynbss; 4948 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 4949 1.1 christos 4950 1.7 christos if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0) 4951 1.1 christos { 4952 1.1 christos asection *srel; 4953 1.1 christos 4954 1.1 christos /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic 4955 1.1 christos linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object 4956 1.7 christos and into the runtime process image. */ 4957 1.10 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs) 4958 1.3 christos srel = htab->relsbss; 4959 1.1 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0) 4960 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro; 4961 1.1 christos else 4962 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelbss; 4963 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL); 4964 1.1 christos srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 4965 1.1 christos h->needs_copy = 1; 4966 1.1 christos } 4967 1.10 christos 4968 1.1 christos /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */ 4969 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 4970 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s); 4971 1.1 christos } 4972 1.1 christos 4973 1.1 christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is 4975 1.1 christos xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0, 4976 1.1 christos specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym 4977 1.1 christos is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC 4978 1.3 christos xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */ 4979 1.1 christos 4980 1.1 christos static bool 4981 1.1 christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent, 4982 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 4983 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 4984 1.1 christos { 4985 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh; 4986 1.1 christos size_t len1, len2, len3; 4987 1.1 christos char *name; 4988 1.12 christos const char *stub; 4989 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 4990 1.10 christos 4991 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 4992 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_pic32."; 4993 1.1 christos else 4994 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_call32."; 4995 1.1 christos 4996 1.10 christos len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string); 4997 1.1 christos len2 = strlen (stub); 4998 1.10 christos len3 = 0; 4999 1.1 christos if (ent->sec) 5000 1.1 christos len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name); 5001 1.1 christos name = bfd_alloc (info->output_bfd, len1 + len2 + len3 + 9); 5002 1.1 christos if (name == NULL) 5003 1.1 christos return false; 5004 1.1 christos sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff); 5005 1.1 christos if (ent->sec) 5006 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3); 5007 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2); 5008 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1); 5009 1.3 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false); 5010 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL) 5011 1.10 christos return false; 5012 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new) 5013 1.1 christos { 5014 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined; 5015 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink; 5016 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset; 5017 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1; 5018 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1; 5019 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1; 5020 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1; 5021 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0; 5022 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1; 5023 1.1 christos } 5024 1.1 christos return true; 5025 1.7 christos } 5026 1.7 christos 5027 1.1 christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset. 5028 1.1 christos Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */ 5029 1.1 christos 5030 1.1 christos static bfd_vma 5031 1.1 christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need) 5032 1.1 christos { 5033 1.1 christos bfd_vma where; 5034 1.1 christos unsigned int max_before_header; 5035 1.1 christos 5036 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS) 5037 1.1 christos { 5038 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size; 5039 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need; 5040 1.1 christos } 5041 1.7 christos else 5042 1.7 christos { 5043 1.1 christos max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764; 5044 1.7 christos if (need <= htab->got_gap) 5045 1.7 christos { 5046 1.1 christos where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap; 5047 1.1 christos htab->got_gap -= need; 5048 1.1 christos } 5049 1.1 christos else 5050 1.1 christos { 5051 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header 5052 1.7 christos && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header) 5053 1.7 christos { 5054 1.7 christos htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size; 5055 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size; 5056 1.7 christos } 5057 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size; 5058 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need; 5059 1.7 christos } 5060 1.7 christos } 5061 1.7 christos return where; 5062 1.7 christos } 5063 1.7 christos 5064 1.7 christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK. 5065 1.9 christos TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */ 5066 1.7 christos 5067 1.7 christos static inline unsigned int 5068 1.7 christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask) 5069 1.7 christos { 5070 1.7 christos unsigned int need; 5071 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0) 5072 1.7 christos need = 4; 5073 1.7 christos else 5074 1.7 christos { 5075 1.10 christos need = 0; 5076 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0) 5077 1.7 christos need += 8; 5078 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0) 5079 1.7 christos need += 4; 5080 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0) 5081 1.7 christos need += 4; 5082 1.7 christos } 5083 1.7 christos return need; 5084 1.7 christos } 5085 1.7 christos 5086 1.7 christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */ 5087 1.7 christos 5088 1.7 christos static bool 5089 1.10 christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info, 5090 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 5091 1.10 christos { 5092 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info); 5093 1.10 christos 5094 1.10 christos if (htab->dynamic_sections_created 5095 1.10 christos && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0 5096 1.10 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak) 5097 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined) 5098 1.10 christos && h->dynindx == -1 5099 1.10 christos && !h->forced_local 5100 1.10 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT) 5101 1.10 christos return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h); 5102 1.7 christos return true; 5103 1.7 christos } 5104 1.1 christos 5105 1.1 christos /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the 5106 1.10 christos usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry. */ 5107 1.1 christos 5108 1.1 christos static inline 5109 1.1 christos bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info, 5110 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 5111 1.1 christos { 5112 1.1 christos return (h == NULL 5113 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1 5114 1.1 christos || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created); 5115 1.10 christos } 5116 1.1 christos 5117 1.1 christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */ 5118 1.1 christos 5119 1.3 christos static bool 5120 1.3 christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf) 5121 1.3 christos { 5122 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = inf; 5123 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh; 5124 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 5125 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p; 5126 1.1 christos 5127 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect) 5128 1.7 christos return true; 5129 1.10 christos 5130 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 5131 1.11 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5132 1.11 christos if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0 5133 1.7 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 5134 1.1 christos && !eh->elf.def_regular 5135 1.9 christos && eh->elf.protected_def 5136 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha 5137 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo 5138 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)) 5139 1.7 christos { 5140 1.7 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */ 5141 1.11 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf)) 5142 1.11 christos return false; 5143 1.11 christos 5144 1.11 christos unsigned int need = got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask); 5145 1.1 christos unsigned int rel_need = need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4; 5146 1.1 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) 5147 1.1 christos { 5148 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)) 5149 1.1 christos /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should 5150 1.1 christos always be the case. It's a little odd if we have 5151 1.9 christos a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */ 5152 1.9 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1; 5153 1.9 christos else 5154 1.10 christos { 5155 1.10 christos need += 8; 5156 1.7 christos rel_need += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5157 1.7 christos } 5158 1.7 christos } 5159 1.7 christos if (need == 0) 5160 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5161 1.7 christos else 5162 1.9 christos { 5163 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need); 5164 1.3 christos if (((bfd_link_pic (info) 5165 1.7 christos && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 5166 1.11 christos && bfd_link_executable (info) 5167 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)) 5168 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)) 5169 1.1 christos || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 5170 1.1 christos && eh->elf.dynindx != -1 5171 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))) 5172 1.1 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf)) 5173 1.7 christos { 5174 1.7 christos asection *rsec; 5175 1.7 christos 5176 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.srelgot; 5177 1.10 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 5178 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt; 5179 1.7 christos rsec->size += rel_need; 5180 1.7 christos } 5181 1.7 christos } 5182 1.10 christos } 5183 1.7 christos else 5184 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5185 1.7 christos 5186 1.7 christos /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for 5187 1.10 christos IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */ 5188 1.7 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 5189 1.10 christos && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC) 5190 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 5191 1.1 christos 5192 1.1 christos /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */ 5193 1.1 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined 5194 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT) 5195 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 5196 1.1 christos 5197 1.7 christos /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default 5198 1.1 christos visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */ 5199 1.1 christos else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)) 5200 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 5201 1.1 christos 5202 1.1 christos if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL) 5203 1.1 christos ; 5204 1.1 christos 5205 1.1 christos /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for 5206 1.1 christos dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be 5207 1.1 christos defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard 5208 1.1 christos space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility 5209 1.10 christos changes. */ 5210 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 5211 1.1 christos { 5212 1.1 christos /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn, 5213 1.1 christos or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be 5214 1.7 christos generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to 5215 1.7 christos resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt. 5216 1.7 christos If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected 5217 1.7 christos then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */ 5218 1.7 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)) 5219 1.7 christos { 5220 1.10 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp; 5221 1.7 christos 5222 1.7 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; ) 5223 1.7 christos { 5224 1.10 christos p->count -= p->pc_count; 5225 1.7 christos p->pc_count = 0; 5226 1.7 christos if (p->count == 0) 5227 1.7 christos *pp = p->next; 5228 1.7 christos else 5229 1.7 christos pp = &p->next; 5230 1.7 christos } 5231 1.7 christos } 5232 1.7 christos 5233 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks) 5234 1.7 christos { 5235 1.7 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp; 5236 1.7 christos 5237 1.10 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; ) 5238 1.7 christos { 5239 1.7 christos if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0) 5240 1.7 christos *pp = p->next; 5241 1.7 christos else 5242 1.7 christos pp = &p->next; 5243 1.7 christos } 5244 1.7 christos } 5245 1.10 christos 5246 1.10 christos if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL) 5247 1.10 christos { 5248 1.10 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */ 5249 1.10 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h)) 5250 1.7 christos return false; 5251 1.7 christos } 5252 1.7 christos } 5253 1.7 christos else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS) 5254 1.7 christos { 5255 1.7 christos /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against 5256 1.7 christos symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not 5257 1.7 christos dynamic. */ 5258 1.7 christos if ((h->dynamic_adjusted 5259 1.10 christos || (h->ref_regular 5260 1.7 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak 5261 1.7 christos && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0 5262 1.10 christos || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h)))) 5263 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular 5264 1.7 christos && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h) 5265 1.10 christos && !(h->protected_def 5266 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha 5267 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo 5268 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)) 5269 1.10 christos { 5270 1.11 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */ 5271 1.11 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h)) 5272 1.11 christos return false; 5273 1.11 christos 5274 1.11 christos if (h->dynindx == -1) 5275 1.11 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 5276 1.11 christos } 5277 1.7 christos else 5278 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL; 5279 1.7 christos } 5280 1.7 christos 5281 1.7 christos /* Allocate space. */ 5282 1.7 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next) 5283 1.7 christos if (!discarded_section (p->sec)) 5284 1.10 christos { 5285 1.7 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc; 5286 1.7 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 5287 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt; 5288 1.7 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5289 1.7 christos } 5290 1.7 christos 5291 1.7 christos /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled. 5292 1.7 christos We might need a PLT entry when the symbol 5293 1.7 christos a) is dynamic, or 5294 1.7 christos b) is an ifunc, or 5295 1.10 christos c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or 5296 1.7 christos d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */ 5297 1.7 christos if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1) 5298 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC 5299 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted) 5300 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt 5301 1.10 christos && h->def_regular 5302 1.10 christos && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 5303 1.10 christos && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt 5304 1.10 christos && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask 5305 1.10 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP)) 5306 1.7 christos { 5307 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 5308 1.10 christos bool doneone = false; 5309 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5310 1.7 christos 5311 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 5312 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0) 5313 1.7 christos { 5314 1.7 christos asection *s; 5315 1.7 christos bool dyn; 5316 1.7 christos 5317 1.7 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h)) 5318 1.7 christos return false; 5319 1.7 christos 5320 1.7 christos dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h); 5321 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt; 5322 1.7 christos if (!dyn) 5323 1.7 christos { 5324 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 5325 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.iplt; 5326 1.7 christos else 5327 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal; 5328 1.7 christos } 5329 1.7 christos 5330 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn) 5331 1.7 christos { 5332 1.7 christos if (!doneone) 5333 1.7 christos { 5334 1.7 christos plt_offset = s->size; 5335 1.7 christos s->size += 4; 5336 1.7 christos } 5337 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset; 5338 1.7 christos 5339 1.7 christos if (s == htab->pltlocal) 5340 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset; 5341 1.7 christos else 5342 1.7 christos { 5343 1.7 christos s = htab->glink; 5344 1.7 christos if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)) 5345 1.7 christos { 5346 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size; 5347 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h); 5348 1.10 christos } 5349 1.7 christos if (!doneone 5350 1.7 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info) 5351 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic 5352 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular) 5353 1.7 christos { 5354 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s; 5355 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset; 5356 1.7 christos } 5357 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset; 5358 1.7 christos 5359 1.7 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms 5360 1.7 christos && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info)) 5361 1.7 christos return false; 5362 1.7 christos } 5363 1.7 christos } 5364 1.7 christos else 5365 1.7 christos { 5366 1.7 christos if (!doneone) 5367 1.7 christos { 5368 1.7 christos /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room 5369 1.7 christos for the special first entry. */ 5370 1.7 christos if (s->size == 0) 5371 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size; 5372 1.7 christos 5373 1.7 christos /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two 5374 1.7 christos parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load 5375 1.7 christos and a jump), and then there is a remaining 5376 1.7 christos word available at the end. */ 5377 1.7 christos plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size 5378 1.7 christos + (htab->plt_slot_size 5379 1.7 christos * ((s->size 5380 1.7 christos - htab->plt_initial_entry_size) 5381 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size))); 5382 1.7 christos 5383 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular 5384 1.1 christos file, and we are not generating a shared 5385 1.7 christos library, then set the symbol to this location 5386 1.7 christos in the .plt. This is to avoid text 5387 1.7 christos relocations, and is required to make 5388 1.7 christos function pointers compare as equal between 5389 1.7 christos the normal executable and the shared library. */ 5390 1.7 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info) 5391 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic 5392 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular) 5393 1.7 christos { 5394 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s; 5395 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset; 5396 1.7 christos } 5397 1.1 christos 5398 1.7 christos /* Make room for this entry. */ 5399 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size; 5400 1.7 christos /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries 5401 1.7 christos is allocated. */ 5402 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD 5403 1.7 christos && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size) 5404 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size 5405 1.7 christos > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) 5406 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size; 5407 1.7 christos } 5408 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset; 5409 1.7 christos } 5410 1.7 christos 5411 1.7 christos /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */ 5412 1.7 christos if (!doneone) 5413 1.7 christos { 5414 1.7 christos if (!dyn) 5415 1.7 christos { 5416 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 5417 1.1 christos { 5418 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt; 5419 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5420 1.7 christos } 5421 1.7 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 5422 1.7 christos { 5423 1.7 christos s = htab->relpltlocal; 5424 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5425 1.7 christos } 5426 1.7 christos } 5427 1.7 christos else 5428 1.7 christos { 5429 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5430 1.7 christos 5431 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS) 5432 1.7 christos { 5433 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */ 5434 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) 5435 1.7 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 5436 1.1 christos { 5437 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset 5438 1.7 christos == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size) 5439 1.7 christos { 5440 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size 5441 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) 5442 1.10 christos * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS); 5443 1.7 christos } 5444 1.7 christos 5445 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size 5446 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) 5447 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS); 5448 1.7 christos } 5449 1.1 christos 5450 1.7 christos /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in 5451 1.7 christos .got.plt. */ 5452 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4; 5453 1.1 christos } 5454 1.7 christos } 5455 1.1 christos doneone = true; 5456 1.7 christos } 5457 1.7 christos } 5458 1.1 christos else 5459 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5460 1.10 christos 5461 1.1 christos if (!doneone) 5462 1.1 christos { 5463 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL; 5464 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0; 5465 1.1 christos } 5466 1.1 christos } 5467 1.1 christos else 5468 1.1 christos { 5469 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL; 5470 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0; 5471 1.1 christos } 5472 1.1 christos 5473 1.1 christos return true; 5474 1.1 christos } 5475 1.1 christos 5476 1.1 christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] = 5477 1.1 christos { 5478 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */ 5479 1.10 christos 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */ 5480 1.12 christos 1, /* CIE version. */ 5481 1.12 christos 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */ 5482 1.1 christos 4, /* Code alignment. */ 5483 1.1 christos 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */ 5484 1.1 christos 65, /* RA reg. */ 5485 1.10 christos 1, /* Augmentation size. */ 5486 1.1 christos DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */ 5487 1.1 christos DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */ 5488 1.1 christos }; 5489 1.12 christos 5490 1.1 christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */ 5491 1.1 christos 5492 1.1 christos static bool 5493 1.12 christos ppc_elf_late_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd, 5494 1.12 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 5495 1.1 christos { 5496 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 5497 1.1 christos asection *s; 5498 1.1 christos bool relocs; 5499 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd; 5500 1.1 christos 5501 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 5502 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_late_size_sections called\n"); 5503 1.1 christos #endif 5504 1.1 christos 5505 1.12 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 5506 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL) 5507 1.1 christos return true; 5508 1.1 christos 5509 1.1 christos if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 5510 1.1 christos { 5511 1.1 christos /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */ 5512 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp) 5513 1.1 christos { 5514 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp"); 5515 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 5516 1.3 christos s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER; 5517 1.1 christos s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER; 5518 1.1 christos s->alloced = 1; 5519 1.1 christos } 5520 1.1 christos } 5521 1.1 christos 5522 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD) 5523 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 16; 5524 1.1 christos else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW) 5525 1.10 christos htab->got_header_size = 12; 5526 1.10 christos 5527 1.1 christos /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic 5528 1.1 christos relocs. */ 5529 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 5530 1.1 christos { 5531 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got; 5532 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got; 5533 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 5534 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **end_local_plt; 5535 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks; 5536 1.1 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount; 5537 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 5538 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms; 5539 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym; 5540 1.11 christos 5541 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd)) 5542 1.1 christos continue; 5543 1.1 christos 5544 1.1 christos for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 5545 1.1 christos { 5546 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p; 5547 1.10 christos 5548 1.1 christos for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *) 5549 1.1 christos elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel); 5550 1.1 christos p != NULL; 5551 1.1 christos p = p->next) 5552 1.1 christos { 5553 1.1 christos if (discarded_section (p->sec)) 5554 1.1 christos { 5555 1.1 christos /* Input section has been discarded, either because 5556 1.1 christos it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to 5557 1.3 christos linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding 5558 1.7 christos the relocs too. */ 5559 1.1 christos } 5560 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks 5561 1.1 christos && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, 5562 1.1 christos ".tls_vars") == 0) 5563 1.7 christos { 5564 1.7 christos /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are 5565 1.7 christos handled specially by the loader. */ 5566 1.7 christos } 5567 1.7 christos else if (p->count != 0) 5568 1.1 christos { 5569 1.1 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc; 5570 1.1 christos if (p->ifunc) 5571 1.1 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt; 5572 1.1 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5573 1.1 christos if ((p->sec->output_section->flags 5574 1.1 christos & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC)) 5575 1.1 christos == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC)) 5576 1.1 christos { 5577 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL; 5578 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"), 5579 1.1 christos p->sec->owner, p->sec); 5580 1.1 christos } 5581 1.1 christos } 5582 1.10 christos } 5583 1.10 christos } 5584 1.10 christos 5585 1.10 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd); 5586 1.10 christos if (!local_got) 5587 1.10 christos continue; 5588 1.10 christos 5589 1.10 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 5590 1.1 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info; 5591 1.10 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount; 5592 1.10 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got; 5593 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount; 5594 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt; 5595 1.1 christos local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents; 5596 1.7 christos if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0) 5597 1.7 christos { 5598 1.7 christos local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount, 5599 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL); 5600 1.1 christos if (local_syms == NULL) 5601 1.1 christos return false; 5602 1.1 christos } 5603 1.1 christos 5604 1.1 christos for (isym = local_syms; 5605 1.9 christos local_got < end_local_got; 5606 1.9 christos ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym) 5607 1.10 christos if (*local_got > 0) 5608 1.10 christos { 5609 1.3 christos unsigned int need; 5610 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) 5611 1.7 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1; 5612 1.9 christos need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks); 5613 1.7 christos if (need == 0) 5614 1.7 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1; 5615 1.7 christos else 5616 1.7 christos { 5617 1.3 christos *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need); 5618 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 5619 1.1 christos && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0 5620 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)) 5621 1.1 christos && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS) 5622 1.1 christos { 5623 1.10 christos asection *srel; 5624 1.1 christos 5625 1.1 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4; 5626 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelgot; 5627 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC) 5628 1.7 christos srel = htab->elf.irelplt; 5629 1.1 christos srel->size += need; 5630 1.1 christos } 5631 1.10 christos } 5632 1.7 christos } 5633 1.1 christos else 5634 1.1 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1; 5635 1.1 christos 5636 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks) 5637 1.7 christos continue; 5638 1.7 christos 5639 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */ 5640 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt; 5641 1.7 christos for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks) 5642 1.7 christos { 5643 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 5644 1.7 christos bool doneone = false; 5645 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5646 1.7 christos 5647 1.1 christos for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 5648 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0) 5649 1.1 christos { 5650 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC) 5651 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.iplt; 5652 1.1 christos else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt 5653 1.1 christos || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP) 5654 1.1 christos { 5655 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5656 1.1 christos continue; 5657 1.7 christos } 5658 1.1 christos else 5659 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal; 5660 1.1 christos 5661 1.1 christos if (!doneone) 5662 1.1 christos { 5663 1.1 christos plt_offset = s->size; 5664 1.1 christos s->size += 4; 5665 1.7 christos } 5666 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset; 5667 1.7 christos 5668 1.7 christos if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))) 5669 1.7 christos { 5670 1.7 christos s = htab->glink; 5671 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size; 5672 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL); 5673 1.7 christos } 5674 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset; 5675 1.10 christos 5676 1.1 christos if (!doneone) 5677 1.1 christos { 5678 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC) 5679 1.1 christos { 5680 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt; 5681 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5682 1.10 christos } 5683 1.10 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 5684 1.10 christos { 5685 1.10 christos s = htab->relpltlocal; 5686 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5687 1.10 christos } 5688 1.10 christos doneone = true; 5689 1.10 christos } 5690 1.1 christos } 5691 1.1 christos else 5692 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5693 1.1 christos } 5694 1.1 christos 5695 1.1 christos if (local_syms != NULL 5696 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms) 5697 1.1 christos { 5698 1.9 christos if (!info->keep_memory) 5699 1.7 christos free (local_syms); 5700 1.1 christos else 5701 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms; 5702 1.1 christos } 5703 1.1 christos } 5704 1.7 christos 5705 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */ 5706 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info); 5707 1.1 christos 5708 1.1 christos if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0) 5709 1.1 christos { 5710 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8); 5711 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info)) 5712 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 5713 1.1 christos } 5714 1.7 christos else 5715 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 5716 1.1 christos 5717 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS) 5718 1.1 christos { 5719 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = 32768; 5720 1.1 christos 5721 1.1 christos /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here, 5722 1.3 christos for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated), 5723 1.1 christos or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the 5724 1.1 christos corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */ 5725 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768) 5726 1.3 christos { 5727 1.3 christos g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size; 5728 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD) 5729 1.3 christos g_o_t += 4; 5730 1.3 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size; 5731 1.3 christos } 5732 1.3 christos 5733 1.3 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t; 5734 1.3 christos } 5735 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 5736 1.3 christos { 5737 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym; 5738 1.1 christos 5739 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section; 5740 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value; 5741 1.1 christos } 5742 1.1 christos if (info->emitrelocations) 5743 1.1 christos { 5744 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym; 5745 1.1 christos 5746 1.7 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular) 5747 1.7 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP; 5748 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym; 5749 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular) 5750 1.3 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP; 5751 1.1 christos } 5752 1.1 christos 5753 1.3 christos if (htab->glink != NULL 5754 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0 5755 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 5756 1.1 christos { 5757 1.10 christos htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size; 5758 1.1 christos /* Space for the branch table. */ 5759 1.10 christos htab->glink->size 5760 1.1 christos += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4; 5761 1.1 christos /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */ 5762 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround 5763 1.1 christos ? 63 : 15); 5764 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE; 5765 1.1 christos 5766 1.1 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms) 5767 1.1 christos { 5768 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh; 5769 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink", 5770 1.3 christos true, false, false); 5771 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL) 5772 1.1 christos return false; 5773 1.10 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new) 5774 1.1 christos { 5775 1.10 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined; 5776 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink; 5777 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve; 5778 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1; 5779 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1; 5780 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1; 5781 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1; 5782 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0; 5783 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1; 5784 1.1 christos } 5785 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve", 5786 1.3 christos true, false, false); 5787 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL) 5788 1.1 christos return false; 5789 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new) 5790 1.1 christos { 5791 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined; 5792 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink; 5793 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE; 5794 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1; 5795 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1; 5796 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1; 5797 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1; 5798 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0; 5799 1.3 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1; 5800 1.1 christos } 5801 1.1 christos } 5802 1.1 christos } 5803 1.1 christos 5804 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL 5805 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0 5806 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL 5807 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section) 5808 1.1 christos && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info)) 5809 1.10 christos { 5810 1.1 christos s = htab->glink_eh_frame; 5811 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20; 5812 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 5813 1.1 christos { 5814 1.1 christos s->size += 4; 5815 1.1 christos if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256) 5816 1.1 christos s->size += 4; 5817 1.7 christos } 5818 1.7 christos } 5819 1.1 christos 5820 1.1 christos /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. 5821 1.1 christos Allocate memory for them. */ 5822 1.1 christos relocs = false; 5823 1.1 christos for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 5824 1.10 christos { 5825 1.1 christos bool strip_section = true; 5826 1.1 christos 5827 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0) 5828 1.7 christos continue; 5829 1.7 christos 5830 1.1 christos if (s == htab->elf.splt 5831 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgot) 5832 1.7 christos { 5833 1.1 christos /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if 5834 1.7 christos we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them. 5835 1.7 christos It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */ 5836 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL) 5837 1.3 christos strip_section = false; 5838 1.3 christos /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the 5839 1.3 christos comment below. */ 5840 1.3 christos } 5841 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->elf.iplt 5842 1.1 christos || s == htab->pltlocal 5843 1.3 christos || s == htab->glink 5844 1.1 christos || s == htab->glink_eh_frame 5845 1.10 christos || s == htab->elf.sgotplt 5846 1.1 christos || s == htab->sbss 5847 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynbss 5848 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro 5849 1.1 christos || s == htab->dynsbss) 5850 1.10 christos { 5851 1.1 christos /* Strip these too. */ 5852 1.1 christos } 5853 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section 5854 1.1 christos || s == htab->sdata[1].section) 5855 1.1 christos { 5856 1.1 christos strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0; 5857 1.1 christos } 5858 1.1 christos else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela")) 5859 1.1 christos { 5860 1.1 christos if (s->size != 0) 5861 1.1 christos { 5862 1.1 christos /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */ 5863 1.1 christos relocs = true; 5864 1.1 christos 5865 1.1 christos /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need 5866 1.1 christos to copy relocs into the output file. */ 5867 1.1 christos s->reloc_count = 0; 5868 1.1 christos } 5869 1.1 christos } 5870 1.1 christos else 5871 1.1 christos { 5872 1.1 christos /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */ 5873 1.1 christos continue; 5874 1.1 christos } 5875 1.1 christos 5876 1.1 christos if (s->size == 0 && strip_section) 5877 1.1 christos { 5878 1.1 christos /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the 5879 1.1 christos output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and 5880 1.1 christos .rela.plt. We must create both sections in 5881 1.1 christos create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created 5882 1.1 christos before the linker maps input sections to output 5883 1.1 christos sections. The linker does that before 5884 1.10 christos adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that 5885 1.12 christos function which decides whether anything needs to go 5886 1.1 christos into these sections. */ 5887 1.1 christos s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 5888 1.1 christos continue; 5889 1.1 christos } 5890 1.1 christos 5891 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0) 5892 1.1 christos continue; 5893 1.1 christos 5894 1.1 christos /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */ 5895 1.1 christos s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size); 5896 1.1 christos if (s->contents == NULL) 5897 1.1 christos return false; 5898 1.10 christos s->alloced = 1; 5899 1.10 christos } 5900 1.10 christos 5901 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 5902 1.3 christos { 5903 1.3 christos /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the 5904 1.3 christos values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we 5905 1.1 christos must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for 5906 1.1 christos the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the 5907 1.10 christos dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */ 5908 1.3 christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \ 5909 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL) 5910 1.1 christos 5911 1.3 christos if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info, 5912 1.10 christos relocs)) 5913 1.1 christos return false; 5914 1.1 christos 5915 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW 5916 1.1 christos && htab->glink != NULL 5917 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0) 5918 1.1 christos { 5919 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0)) 5920 1.1 christos return false; 5921 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt 5922 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL 5923 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL 5924 1.1 christos && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS)) 5925 1.1 christos return false; 5926 1.1 christos } 5927 1.1 christos } 5928 1.1 christos #undef add_dynamic_entry 5929 1.1 christos 5930 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL 5931 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL) 5932 1.1 christos { 5933 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents; 5934 1.1 christos bfd_vma val; 5935 1.1 christos 5936 1.1 christos memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie)); 5937 1.1 christos /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */ 5938 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p); 5939 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie); 5940 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */ 5941 1.1 christos val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie); 5942 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p); 5943 1.3 christos p += 4; 5944 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */ 5945 1.1 christos val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents; 5946 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p); 5947 1.1 christos p += 4; 5948 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */ 5949 1.1 christos p += 4; 5950 1.1 christos /* .glink size. */ 5951 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p); 5952 1.1 christos p += 4; 5953 1.1 christos /* Augmentation. */ 5954 1.1 christos p += 1; 5955 1.1 christos 5956 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 5957 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 5958 1.1 christos { 5959 1.1 christos bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2; 5960 1.1 christos if (adv < 64) 5961 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv; 5962 1.1 christos else if (adv < 256) 5963 1.1 christos { 5964 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1; 5965 1.1 christos *p++ = adv; 5966 1.1 christos } 5967 1.1 christos else if (adv < 65536) 5968 1.1 christos { 5969 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2; 5970 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p); 5971 1.1 christos p += 2; 5972 1.1 christos } 5973 1.1 christos else 5974 1.1 christos { 5975 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4; 5976 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p); 5977 1.10 christos p += 4; 5978 1.1 christos } 5979 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_register; 5980 1.3 christos *p++ = 65; 5981 1.3 christos p++; 5982 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4; 5983 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended; 5984 1.3 christos *p++ = 65; 5985 1.3 christos } 5986 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4) 5987 1.3 christos == htab->glink_eh_frame->size); 5988 1.3 christos } 5989 1.3 christos 5990 1.3 christos return true; 5991 1.3 christos } 5992 1.3 christos 5993 1.3 christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output 5994 1.3 christos if it looks like nothing is using them. */ 5995 1.3 christos 5996 1.3 christos static void 5997 1.3 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect) 5998 1.3 christos { 5999 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym; 6000 1.3 christos 6001 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1) 6002 1.3 christos { 6003 1.3 christos asection *s; 6004 1.3 christos 6005 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name); 6006 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s)) 6007 1.3 christos { 6008 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name); 6009 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s)) 6010 1.3 christos { 6011 1.3 christos sda->def_regular = 0; 6012 1.3 christos /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */ 6013 1.3 christos sda->ref_dynamic = 1; 6014 1.3 christos sda->forced_local = 0; 6015 1.3 christos } 6016 1.3 christos } 6017 1.3 christos } 6018 1.3 christos } 6019 1.3 christos 6020 1.1 christos void 6021 1.1 christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info) 6022 1.10 christos { 6023 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 6024 1.1 christos 6025 1.1 christos if (htab != NULL) 6026 1.1 christos { 6027 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]); 6028 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]); 6029 1.10 christos } 6030 1.1 christos } 6031 1.1 christos 6032 1.1 christos 6033 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */ 6034 1.1 christos 6035 1.1 christos static bool 6036 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 6037 1.1 christos { 6038 1.1 christos if (h->plt.plist != NULL 6039 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular 6040 1.1 christos && (!h->pointer_equality_needed 6041 1.1 christos || !h->ref_regular_nonweak)) 6042 1.1 christos return false; 6043 1.1 christos 6044 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h); 6045 1.1 christos } 6046 1.1 christos 6047 1.1 christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0])) 6049 1.1 christos 6050 1.1 christos /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is 6051 1.1 christos used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */ 6052 1.1 christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] = 6053 1.1 christos { 6054 1.1 christos 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */ 6055 1.1 christos 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */ 6056 1.1 christos 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */ 6057 1.1 christos 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */ 6058 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */ 6059 1.3 christos 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */ 6060 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */ 6061 1.3 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 6062 1.3 christos }; 6063 1.3 christos 6064 1.3 christos static const int stub_entry[] = 6065 1.3 christos { 6066 1.3 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */ 6067 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */ 6068 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */ 6069 1.10 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */ 6070 1.1 christos }; 6071 1.1 christos 6072 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info 6073 1.10 christos { 6074 1.1 christos unsigned int workaround_size; 6075 1.3 christos unsigned int picfixup_size; 6076 1.1 christos }; 6077 1.3 christos 6078 1.1 christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476 6079 1.1 christos icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch 6080 1.1 christos space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can 6081 1.1 christos add trampolines at the end of the section. */ 6082 1.1 christos 6083 1.1 christos static bool 6084 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd, 6085 1.1 christos asection *isec, 6086 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info, 6087 1.1 christos bool *again) 6088 1.1 christos { 6089 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup 6090 1.3 christos { 6091 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *next; 6092 1.1 christos asection *tsec; 6093 1.10 christos /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a 6094 1.1 christos relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */ 6095 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff; 6096 1.1 christos bfd_vma trampoff; 6097 1.10 christos }; 6098 1.1 christos 6099 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 6100 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents = NULL; 6101 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL; 6102 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL; 6103 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL; 6104 1.11 christos struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL; 6105 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL; 6106 1.3 christos unsigned changes = 0; 6107 1.10 christos bool workaround_change; 6108 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 6109 1.1 christos bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size; 6110 1.1 christos asection *got2; 6111 1.1 christos bool maybe_pasted; 6112 1.3 christos 6113 1.10 christos *again = false; 6114 1.3 christos 6115 1.3 christos /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */ 6116 1.3 christos if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 6117 1.10 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0 6118 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0 6119 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0 6120 1.3 christos || isec->size < 4) 6121 1.3 christos return true; 6122 1.3 christos 6123 1.3 christos /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't 6124 1.3 christos do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r 6125 1.3 christos anyway. */ 6126 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info)) 6127 1.3 christos return true; 6128 1.3 christos 6129 1.3 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info); 6130 1.3 christos if (htab == NULL) 6131 1.3 christos return true; 6132 1.3 christos 6133 1.3 christos isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4; 6134 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0) 6135 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size; 6136 1.10 christos trampbase = isec->size; 6137 1.3 christos 6138 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE 6139 1.3 christos || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET); 6140 1.3 christos isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET; 6141 1.1 christos 6142 1.1 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround 6143 1.1 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0) 6144 1.1 christos { 6145 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL) 6146 1.3 christos { 6147 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info 6148 1.1 christos = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info)); 6149 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL) 6150 1.3 christos return false; 6151 1.3 christos } 6152 1.3 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info; 6153 1.3 christos trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size; 6154 1.3 christos } 6155 1.3 christos 6156 1.3 christos maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0 6157 1.3 christos || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0); 6158 1.3 christos /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */ 6159 1.3 christos trampoff = trampbase; 6160 1.3 christos if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize) 6161 1.3 christos trampoff += 4; 6162 1.1 christos 6163 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd); 6164 1.1 christos picfixup_size = 0; 6165 1.3 christos if (htab->params->branch_trampolines 6166 1.3 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0) 6167 1.1 christos { 6168 1.3 christos /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */ 6169 1.3 christos if (isec->reloc_count != 0) 6170 1.3 christos { 6171 1.3 christos internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL, 6172 1.3 christos link_info->keep_memory); 6173 1.11 christos if (internal_relocs == NULL) 6174 1.3 christos goto error_return; 6175 1.3 christos } 6176 1.3 christos 6177 1.7 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2"); 6178 1.3 christos 6179 1.3 christos irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count; 6180 1.3 christos for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++) 6181 1.3 christos { 6182 1.3 christos unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info); 6183 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff, roff; 6184 1.3 christos asection *tsec; 6185 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f; 6186 1.7 christos size_t insn_offset = 0; 6187 1.3 christos bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val, reladdr; 6188 1.3 christos bfd_byte *hit_addr; 6189 1.1 christos unsigned long t0; 6190 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 6191 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym; 6192 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **plist; 6193 1.3 christos unsigned char sym_type; 6194 1.3 christos 6195 1.1 christos switch (r_type) 6196 1.3 christos { 6197 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24: 6198 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC: 6199 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24: 6200 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL: 6201 1.3 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 25; 6202 1.3 christos break; 6203 1.3 christos 6204 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14: 6205 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 6206 1.7 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 6207 1.7 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 15; 6208 1.7 christos break; 6209 1.7 christos 6210 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA: 6211 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0) 6212 1.7 christos break; 6213 1.7 christos continue; 6214 1.3 christos 6215 1.3 christos default: 6216 1.9 christos continue; 6217 1.9 christos } 6218 1.3 christos 6219 1.3 christos /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */ 6220 1.3 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf, 6221 1.1 christos ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd)) 6222 1.1 christos goto error_return; 6223 1.3 christos 6224 1.7 christos if (isym != NULL) 6225 1.7 christos { 6226 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL) 6227 1.3 christos ; 6228 1.3 christos else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS) 6229 1.7 christos tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr; 6230 1.7 christos else 6231 1.7 christos continue; 6232 1.3 christos 6233 1.3 christos toff = isym->st_value; 6234 1.3 christos sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info); 6235 1.3 christos } 6236 1.3 christos else 6237 1.3 christos { 6238 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL) 6239 1.3 christos toff = h->root.u.def.value; 6240 1.3 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined 6241 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak) 6242 1.3 christos { 6243 1.3 christos unsigned long indx; 6244 1.3 christos 6245 1.3 christos indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info; 6246 1.3 christos tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr; 6247 1.3 christos toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0; 6248 1.3 christos } 6249 1.3 christos else 6250 1.3 christos continue; 6251 1.3 christos 6252 1.3 christos /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later 6253 1.3 christos optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long- 6254 1.3 christos branch stub in that case. */ 6255 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_executable (link_info) 6256 1.3 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr 6257 1.3 christos && irel != internal_relocs) 6258 1.3 christos { 6259 1.3 christos unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info); 6260 1.3 christos unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info); 6261 1.3 christos unsigned int tls_mask = 0; 6262 1.3 christos 6263 1.3 christos /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or 6264 1.3 christos R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc 6265 1.3 christos on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls 6266 1.3 christos mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */ 6267 1.3 christos if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info) 6268 1.3 christos { 6269 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd); 6270 1.3 christos 6271 1.3 christos if (local_got_offsets != NULL) 6272 1.3 christos { 6273 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) 6274 1.1 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 6275 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks = (char *) 6276 1.3 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 6277 1.3 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx]; 6278 1.1 christos } 6279 1.3 christos } 6280 1.3 christos else 6281 1.3 christos { 6282 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *th 6283 1.3 christos = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]; 6284 1.3 christos 6285 1.3 christos while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 6286 1.3 christos || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 6287 1.3 christos th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link; 6288 1.3 christos 6289 1.3 christos tls_mask 6290 1.3 christos = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask; 6291 1.3 christos } 6292 1.1 christos 6293 1.3 christos /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be 6294 1.3 christos optimised away. */ 6295 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0 6296 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD 6297 1.1 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 6298 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO)) 6299 1.3 christos continue; 6300 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0 6301 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD 6302 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 6303 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO)) 6304 1.3 christos continue; 6305 1.1 christos } 6306 1.3 christos 6307 1.3 christos sym_type = h->type; 6308 1.3 christos } 6309 1.3 christos 6310 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA) 6311 1.3 christos { 6312 1.3 christos if (h != NULL 6313 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular 6314 1.3 christos && h->protected_def 6315 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha 6316 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo) 6317 1.3 christos picfixup_size += 12; 6318 1.3 christos continue; 6319 1.3 christos } 6320 1.3 christos 6321 1.3 christos /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must 6322 1.3 christos match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here 6323 1.3 christos but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch 6324 1.3 christos destination used here may be incorrect. */ 6325 1.3 christos plist = NULL; 6326 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 6327 1.3 christos { 6328 1.3 christos /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */ 6329 1.3 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC 6330 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24) 6331 1.1 christos plist = &h->plt.plist; 6332 1.3 christos } 6333 1.3 christos else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC 6334 1.3 christos && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL) 6335 1.3 christos { 6336 1.1 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd); 6337 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) 6338 1.3 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 6339 1.3 christos plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info); 6340 1.3 christos } 6341 1.3 christos if (plist != NULL) 6342 1.3 christos { 6343 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend = 0; 6344 1.3 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 6345 1.3 christos 6346 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info)) 6347 1.7 christos addend = irel->r_addend; 6348 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend); 6349 1.3 christos if (ent != NULL) 6350 1.1 christos { 6351 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW 6352 1.1 christos || h == NULL 6353 1.3 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 6354 1.3 christos || h->dynindx == -1) 6355 1.3 christos { 6356 1.3 christos tsec = htab->glink; 6357 1.3 christos toff = ent->glink_offset; 6358 1.3 christos } 6359 1.9 christos else 6360 1.9 christos { 6361 1.9 christos tsec = htab->elf.splt; 6362 1.9 christos toff = ent->plt.offset; 6363 1.9 christos } 6364 1.9 christos } 6365 1.9 christos } 6366 1.9 christos 6367 1.9 christos /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have 6368 1.9 christos no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the 6369 1.9 christos branch overflow. */ 6370 1.3 christos if (tsec == isec) 6371 1.3 christos continue; 6372 1.3 christos 6373 1.3 christos /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is 6374 1.3 christos undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't 6375 1.3 christos support addends. It would be possible to do so by 6376 1.3 christos putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on 6377 1.3 christos branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */ 6378 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) 6379 1.3 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr 6380 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24 6381 1.3 christos && irel->r_addend != 0) 6382 1.3 christos continue; 6383 1.3 christos 6384 1.3 christos /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in 6385 1.3 christos SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely 6386 1.3 christos attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at 6387 1.3 christos branches. However, implement it correctly here as a 6388 1.3 christos reference for other target relax_section functions. */ 6389 1.3 christos if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE) 6390 1.3 christos { 6391 1.3 christos /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been 6392 1.3 christos adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be 6393 1.9 christos passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in 6394 1.9 christos relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for 6395 1.3 christos section symbols have been adjusted.) 6396 1.3 christos 6397 1.3 christos gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE 6398 1.3 christos sections to a relocation against the section symbol when 6399 1.3 christos the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against 6400 1.3 christos a section symbol we should include the addend in the 6401 1.1 christos offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the 6402 1.9 christos location of interest is the original symbol. On the 6403 1.9 christos other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not 6404 1.3 christos a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an 6405 1.3 christos access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The 6406 1.3 christos location of interest is just "sym". */ 6407 1.3 christos if (sym_type == STT_SECTION 6408 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24) 6409 1.1 christos toff += irel->r_addend; 6410 1.3 christos 6411 1.3 christos toff 6412 1.3 christos = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec, 6413 1.3 christos elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info, 6414 1.3 christos toff); 6415 1.3 christos 6416 1.3 christos if (sym_type != STT_SECTION 6417 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24) 6418 1.3 christos toff += irel->r_addend; 6419 1.11 christos } 6420 1.1 christos /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */ 6421 1.9 christos else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24) 6422 1.9 christos toff += irel->r_addend; 6423 1.9 christos 6424 1.9 christos /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */ 6425 1.9 christos if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) 6426 1.9 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr) 6427 1.9 christos || tsec->output_section == NULL 6428 1.9 christos || (tsec->owner != NULL 6429 1.9 christos && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0)) 6430 1.9 christos continue; 6431 1.3 christos 6432 1.3 christos roff = irel->r_offset; 6433 1.3 christos reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff; 6434 1.3 christos 6435 1.3 christos /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when 6436 1.3 christos relocatable if the output section size is such that a 6437 1.3 christos fixup can be created at final link. 6438 1.11 christos The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number 6439 1.3 christos of other fixups being needed at final link. */ 6440 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) 6441 1.3 christos && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff) 6442 1.3 christos < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4))) 6443 1.3 christos continue; 6444 1.3 christos 6445 1.1 christos /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */ 6446 1.3 christos if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr 6447 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) 6448 1.3 christos /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during 6449 1.3 christos final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */ 6450 1.1 christos || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section)) 6451 1.3 christos { 6452 1.3 christos bfd_vma symaddr; 6453 1.3 christos 6454 1.3 christos symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff; 6455 1.1 christos if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset 6456 1.3 christos < 2 * max_branch_offset) 6457 1.3 christos continue; 6458 1.3 christos } 6459 1.3 christos 6460 1.3 christos /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */ 6461 1.1 christos for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next) 6462 1.3 christos if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff) 6463 1.3 christos break; 6464 1.3 christos 6465 1.3 christos if (f == NULL) 6466 1.3 christos { 6467 1.3 christos size_t size; 6468 1.3 christos unsigned long stub_rtype; 6469 1.3 christos 6470 1.3 christos val = trampoff - roff; 6471 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset) 6472 1.3 christos /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add 6473 1.7 christos one. We'll report an error later. */ 6474 1.3 christos continue; 6475 1.3 christos 6476 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (link_info)) 6477 1.3 christos { 6478 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry); 6479 1.3 christos insn_offset = 12; 6480 1.1 christos } 6481 1.3 christos else 6482 1.3 christos { 6483 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry); 6484 1.3 christos insn_offset = 0; 6485 1.3 christos } 6486 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX; 6487 1.3 christos if (tsec == htab->elf.splt 6488 1.3 christos || tsec == htab->glink) 6489 1.3 christos { 6490 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT; 6491 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24) 6492 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24; 6493 1.3 christos } 6494 1.3 christos 6495 1.3 christos /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two 6496 1.3 christos relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */ 6497 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), 6498 1.3 christos stub_rtype); 6499 1.3 christos irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset; 6500 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 6501 1.1 christos && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24) 6502 1.1 christos irel->r_addend = 0; 6503 1.3 christos 6504 1.3 christos /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */ 6505 1.3 christos f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f)); 6506 1.3 christos f->next = branch_fixups; 6507 1.3 christos f->tsec = tsec; 6508 1.3 christos f->toff = toff; 6509 1.1 christos f->trampoff = trampoff; 6510 1.1 christos branch_fixups = f; 6511 1.11 christos 6512 1.11 christos trampoff += size; 6513 1.11 christos changes++; 6514 1.11 christos } 6515 1.11 christos else 6516 1.11 christos { 6517 1.3 christos val = f->trampoff - roff; 6518 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset) 6519 1.1 christos continue; 6520 1.3 christos 6521 1.3 christos /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */ 6522 1.3 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE); 6523 1.1 christos } 6524 1.3 christos 6525 1.1 christos link_info->callbacks->minfo 6526 1.1 christos (_("%pB: Adjusting branch at 0x%V towards \"%s\" in section %s\n"), 6527 1.1 christos abfd, reladdr, 6528 1.3 christos (h && h->root.root.string? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"), 6529 1.3 christos f->tsec->name); 6530 1.3 christos 6531 1.3 christos /* Get the section contents. */ 6532 1.3 christos if (contents == NULL) 6533 1.3 christos { 6534 1.3 christos /* Get cached copy if it exists. */ 6535 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL) 6536 1.3 christos contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents; 6537 1.3 christos /* Go get them off disk. */ 6538 1.3 christos else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents)) 6539 1.3 christos goto error_return; 6540 1.1 christos } 6541 1.3 christos 6542 1.3 christos /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */ 6543 1.3 christos hit_addr = contents + roff; 6544 1.3 christos switch (r_type) 6545 1.3 christos { 6546 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24: 6547 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC: 6548 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24: 6549 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr); 6550 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0x3fffffc; 6551 1.1 christos t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc; 6552 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr); 6553 1.1 christos break; 6554 1.3 christos 6555 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14: 6556 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 6557 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 6558 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr); 6559 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0xfffc; 6560 1.10 christos t0 |= val & 0xfffc; 6561 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr); 6562 1.3 christos break; 6563 1.3 christos } 6564 1.3 christos } 6565 1.3 christos 6566 1.3 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL) 6567 1.3 christos { 6568 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups; 6569 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next; 6570 1.3 christos free (f); 6571 1.3 christos } 6572 1.3 christos } 6573 1.3 christos 6574 1.3 christos workaround_change = false; 6575 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff; 6576 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround 6577 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) 6578 1.3 christos || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)) 6579 1.3 christos { 6580 1.3 christos bfd_vma addr, end_addr; 6581 1.3 christos unsigned int crossings; 6582 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2; 6583 1.3 christos 6584 1.10 christos addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset; 6585 1.3 christos end_addr = addr + trampoff; 6586 1.3 christos addr &= -pagesize; 6587 1.3 christos crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2; 6588 1.1 christos if (crossings != 0) 6589 1.3 christos { 6590 1.3 christos /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does 6591 1.1 christos not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a 6592 1.3 christos previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */ 6593 1.3 christos newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15); 6594 1.3 christos newsize += crossings * 16; 6595 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize) 6596 1.3 christos { 6597 1.3 christos relax_info->workaround_size = newsize; 6598 1.3 christos workaround_change = true; 6599 1.1 christos } 6600 1.3 christos /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */ 6601 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC; 6602 1.1 christos } 6603 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size; 6604 1.1 christos } 6605 1.1 christos 6606 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0) 6607 1.1 christos { 6608 1.1 christos picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size; 6609 1.1 christos if (picfixup_size != 0) 6610 1.1 christos relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size; 6611 1.1 christos newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size; 6612 1.1 christos } 6613 1.1 christos 6614 1.1 christos if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change) 6615 1.1 christos isec->size = newsize; 6616 1.1 christos 6617 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL 6618 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf) 6619 1.1 christos { 6620 1.1 christos if (! link_info->keep_memory) 6621 1.1 christos free (isymbuf); 6622 1.1 christos else 6623 1.1 christos { 6624 1.1 christos /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */ 6625 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf; 6626 1.1 christos } 6627 1.3 christos } 6628 1.1 christos 6629 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL 6630 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents) 6631 1.1 christos { 6632 1.12 christos if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory) 6633 1.12 christos free (contents); 6634 1.12 christos else 6635 1.12 christos { 6636 1.12 christos /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */ 6637 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents; 6638 1.12 christos } 6639 1.1 christos } 6640 1.12 christos 6641 1.1 christos changes += picfixup_size; 6642 1.1 christos if (changes != 0) 6643 1.10 christos { 6644 1.1 christos /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation 6645 1.1 christos information for the trampolines. */ 6646 1.3 christos size_t old_size = isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*internal_relocs); 6647 1.10 christos size_t extra_size = changes * sizeof (*internal_relocs); 6648 1.1 christos internal_relocs = bfd_realloc (internal_relocs, old_size + extra_size); 6649 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = internal_relocs; 6650 1.3 christos if (!internal_relocs) 6651 1.3 christos goto error_return; 6652 1.3 christos memset ((char *) internal_relocs + old_size, 0, extra_size); 6653 1.3 christos isec->reloc_count += changes; 6654 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec); 6655 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize; 6656 1.10 christos } 6657 1.1 christos else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs) 6658 1.10 christos free (internal_relocs); 6659 1.1 christos 6660 1.10 christos *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change; 6661 1.1 christos return true; 6662 1.10 christos 6663 1.1 christos error_return: 6664 1.1 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL) 6665 1.1 christos { 6666 1.1 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups; 6667 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next; 6668 1.1 christos free (f); 6669 1.1 christos } 6670 1.1 christos if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents) 6671 1.1 christos free (isymbuf); 6672 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents) 6673 1.1 christos free (contents); 6674 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs) 6675 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs); 6676 1.1 christos return false; 6677 1.1 christos } 6678 1.1 christos 6679 1.1 christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in 6681 1.1 christos discarded sections. */ 6682 1.1 christos 6683 1.1 christos static unsigned int 6684 1.1 christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec) 6685 1.1 christos { 6686 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0) 6687 1.1 christos return 0; 6688 1.1 christos 6689 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0) 6690 1.1 christos return 0; 6691 1.1 christos 6692 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec); 6693 1.1 christos } 6694 1.1 christos 6695 1.1 christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */ 6697 1.1 christos 6698 1.1 christos static bfd_vma 6699 1.1 christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd, 6700 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect, 6701 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 6702 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation, 6703 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel) 6704 1.1 christos { 6705 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr; 6706 1.1 christos 6707 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL); 6708 1.1 christos 6709 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 6710 1.1 christos { 6711 1.1 christos /* Handle global symbol. */ 6712 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh; 6713 1.1 christos 6714 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 6715 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular); 6716 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer; 6717 1.1 christos } 6718 1.1 christos else 6719 1.1 christos { 6720 1.1 christos /* Handle local symbol. */ 6721 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 6722 1.1 christos 6723 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd)); 6724 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL); 6725 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx]; 6726 1.1 christos } 6727 1.1 christos 6728 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr, 6729 1.1 christos rel->r_addend, 6730 1.1 christos lsect); 6731 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL); 6732 1.1 christos 6733 1.1 christos /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit 6734 1.1 christos as a "written" flag. */ 6735 1.1 christos if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0) 6736 1.1 christos { 6737 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner, 6738 1.1 christos relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend, 6739 1.1 christos lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset); 6740 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset += 1; 6741 1.1 christos } 6742 1.1 christos 6743 1.1 christos relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma 6744 1.1 christos + lsect->section->output_offset 6745 1.1 christos + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1 6746 1.7 christos - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym)); 6747 1.7 christos 6748 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 6749 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, 6750 1.1 christos "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n", 6751 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation); 6752 1.1 christos #endif 6753 1.7 christos 6754 1.7 christos return relocation; 6755 1.7 christos } 6756 1.7 christos 6757 1.7 christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff) 6758 1.7 christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff) 6759 1.7 christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000) 6760 1.7 christos 6761 1.7 christos static void 6762 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent, 6763 1.7 christos asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p, 6764 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 6765 1.7 christos { 6766 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 6767 1.7 christos bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd; 6768 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt; 6769 1.7 christos unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h); 6770 1.7 christos 6771 1.7 christos if (h != NULL 6772 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr 6773 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt) 6774 1.7 christos { 6775 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p); 6776 1.1 christos p += 4; 6777 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p); 6778 1.1 christos p += 4; 6779 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p); 6780 1.1 christos p += 4; 6781 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p); 6782 1.1 christos p += 4; 6783 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p); 6784 1.1 christos p += 4; 6785 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p); 6786 1.1 christos p += 4; 6787 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p); 6788 1.1 christos p += 4; 6789 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p); 6790 1.1 christos p += 4; 6791 1.1 christos } 6792 1.1 christos 6793 1.1 christos plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1) 6794 1.1 christos + plt_sec->output_section->vma 6795 1.7 christos + plt_sec->output_offset); 6796 1.1 christos 6797 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 6798 1.1 christos { 6799 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0; 6800 1.1 christos 6801 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768) 6802 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend 6803 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma 6804 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset); 6805 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL) 6806 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot); 6807 1.1 christos 6808 1.7 christos plt -= got; 6809 1.7 christos 6810 1.7 christos if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000) 6811 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p); 6812 1.7 christos else 6813 1.7 christos { 6814 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p); 6815 1.7 christos p += 4; 6816 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p); 6817 1.1 christos } 6818 1.1 christos } 6819 1.1 christos else 6820 1.1 christos { 6821 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p); 6822 1.1 christos p += 4; 6823 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p); 6824 1.1 christos } 6825 1.1 christos p += 4; 6826 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p); 6827 1.1 christos p += 4; 6828 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p); 6829 1.1 christos p += 4; 6830 1.1 christos while (p < end) 6831 1.1 christos { 6832 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p); 6833 1.1 christos p += 4; 6834 1.1 christos } 6835 1.1 christos } 6836 1.1 christos 6837 1.1 christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */ 6838 1.1 christos 6839 1.1 christos static bool 6840 1.1 christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 6841 1.9 christos { 6842 1.1 christos return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 6843 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) 6844 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section != NULL 6845 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL); 6846 1.1 christos } 6847 1.1 christos 6848 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return 6849 1.1 christos the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If 6850 1.1 christos REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */ 6851 1.1 christos 6852 1.1 christos unsigned int 6853 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg) 6854 1.1 christos { 6855 1.1 christos unsigned int rtra; 6856 1.1 christos 6857 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26) 6858 1.1 christos return 0; 6859 1.9 christos 6860 1.1 christos if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg) 6861 1.1 christos rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16)); 6862 1.9 christos else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg) 6863 1.1 christos rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5); 6864 1.1 christos else 6865 1.9 christos return 0; 6866 1.1 christos 6867 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1) 6868 1.1 christos /* add -> addi. */ 6869 1.1 christos insn = 14 << 26; 6870 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1 6871 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6 6872 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6 6873 1.1 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6))) 6874 1.1 christos /* load and store indexed -> dform. */ 6875 1.1 christos insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26; 6876 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1) 6877 1.1 christos /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */ 6878 1.1 christos insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1); 6879 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1) 6880 1.9 christos /* lwax -> lwa. */ 6881 1.9 christos insn = (58u << 26) | 2; 6882 1.9 christos else 6883 1.9 christos return 0; 6884 1.9 christos insn |= rtra; 6885 1.9 christos return insn; 6886 1.9 christos } 6887 1.9 christos 6888 1.9 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return 6889 1.9 christos the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the 6890 1.9 christos thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */ 6891 1.9 christos 6892 1.9 christos unsigned int 6893 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg) 6894 1.9 christos { 6895 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16 6896 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */ 6897 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */ 6898 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */ 6899 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */ 6900 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */ 6901 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */ 6902 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */ 6903 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */ 6904 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */ 6905 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */ 6906 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */ 6907 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */ 6908 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */ 6909 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */ 6910 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */ 6911 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */ 6912 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) != 1) 6913 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */ 6914 1.1 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))) 6915 1.1 christos { 6916 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16); 6917 1.10 christos } 6918 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21 6919 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */ 6920 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */ 6921 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */)) 6922 1.9 christos { 6923 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 21); 6924 1.1 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5; 6925 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */) 6926 1.10 christos insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */ 6927 1.1 christos } 6928 1.1 christos else 6929 1.9 christos insn = 0; 6930 1.9 christos return insn; 6931 1.3 christos } 6932 1.1 christos 6933 1.1 christos static bool 6934 1.11 christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn) 6935 1.11 christos { 6936 1.11 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */ 6937 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */ 6938 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */ 6939 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */); 6940 1.11 christos } 6941 1.11 christos 6942 1.11 christos static bool 6943 1.11 christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn) 6944 1.11 christos { 6945 1.11 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */ 6946 1.11 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */ 6947 1.11 christos && (insn & 3) == 1)); 6948 1.11 christos } 6949 1.11 christos 6950 1.11 christos static bool 6951 1.1 christos swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, bfd_byte *loc, asection *s) 6952 1.1 christos { 6953 1.1 christos if ((size_t) (loc - s->contents) >= s->size) 6954 1.1 christos return false; 6955 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (obfd, rel, loc); 6956 1.1 christos return true; 6957 1.1 christos } 6958 1.1 christos 6959 1.1 christos static bool 6960 1.1 christos count_and_swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, asection *s) 6961 1.1 christos { 6962 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc = s->contents; 6963 1.1 christos loc += s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 6964 1.1 christos return swap_reloc_out (obfd, rel, loc, s); 6965 1.1 christos } 6966 1.1 christos 6967 1.1 christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker 6968 1.1 christos to handle the relocations for a section. 6969 1.1 christos 6970 1.1 christos The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section 6971 1.1 christos actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be 6972 1.1 christos zero. 6973 1.1 christos 6974 1.1 christos This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as 6975 1.1 christos necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a 6976 1.1 christos relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as 6977 1.1 christos necessary. 6978 1.1 christos 6979 1.1 christos This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc 6980 1.10 christos address or the reloc symbol index. 6981 1.1 christos 6982 1.1 christos LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols. 6983 1.1 christos 6984 1.1 christos LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file 6985 1.1 christos corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol. 6986 1.1 christos 6987 1.1 christos The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found 6988 1.1 christos via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd). 6989 1.1 christos 6990 1.1 christos When generating relocatable output, this function must handle 6991 1.1 christos STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is 6992 1.1 christos going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output 6993 1.1 christos section, which means that the addend must be adjusted 6994 1.3 christos accordingly. */ 6995 1.1 christos 6996 1.1 christos static int 6997 1.3 christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, 6998 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 6999 1.10 christos bfd *input_bfd, 7000 1.7 christos asection *input_section, 7001 1.10 christos bfd_byte *contents, 7002 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, 7003 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms, 7004 1.1 christos asection **local_sections) 7005 1.1 christos { 7006 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 7007 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 7008 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 7009 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel; 7010 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel; 7011 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relend; 7012 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela outrel; 7013 1.9 christos asection *got2; 7014 1.9 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets; 7015 1.9 christos bool ret = true; 7016 1.10 christos bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0); 7017 1.9 christos bool is_vxworks_tls; 7018 1.9 christos unsigned int picfixup_size = 0; 7019 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL; 7020 1.1 christos 7021 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 7022 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, " 7023 1.1 christos "%ld relocations%s", 7024 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, 7025 1.1 christos (long) input_section->reloc_count, 7026 1.1 christos (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : ""); 7027 1.1 christos #endif 7028 1.1 christos 7029 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd)) 7030 1.1 christos { 7031 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format); 7032 1.1 christos return false; 7033 1.1 christos } 7034 1.3 christos 7035 1.3 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2"); 7036 1.3 christos 7037 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */ 7038 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32]) 7039 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (); 7040 1.1 christos 7041 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 7042 1.1 christos local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd); 7043 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd); 7044 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd); 7045 1.1 christos /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections 7046 1.1 christos specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */ 7047 1.1 christos is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info) 7048 1.1 christos && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, 7049 1.1 christos ".tls_vars")); 7050 1.1 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET) 7051 1.10 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info; 7052 1.10 christos rel = wrel = relocs; 7053 1.1 christos relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count; 7054 1.7 christos for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++) 7055 1.3 christos { 7056 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 7057 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend; 7058 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_status_type r; 7059 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 7060 1.1 christos asection *sec; 7061 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 7062 1.10 christos const char *sym_name; 7063 1.10 christos reloc_howto_type *howto; 7064 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx; 7065 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation; 7066 1.1 christos bfd_vma branch_bit, from; 7067 1.1 christos bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc; 7068 1.1 christos bool warned; 7069 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd; 7070 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list; 7071 1.1 christos struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto; 7072 1.1 christos 7073 1.1 christos again: 7074 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info); 7075 1.1 christos sym = NULL; 7076 1.10 christos sec = NULL; 7077 1.3 christos h = NULL; 7078 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 7079 1.1 christos warned = false; 7080 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info); 7081 1.3 christos 7082 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info) 7083 1.1 christos { 7084 1.1 christos sym = local_syms + r_symndx; 7085 1.1 christos sec = local_sections[r_symndx]; 7086 1.1 christos sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec); 7087 1.1 christos 7088 1.1 christos relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel); 7089 1.1 christos } 7090 1.1 christos else 7091 1.1 christos { 7092 1.1 christos bool ignored; 7093 1.1 christos 7094 1.3 christos RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel, 7095 1.3 christos r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes, 7096 1.9 christos h, sec, relocation, 7097 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored); 7098 1.3 christos 7099 1.3 christos sym_name = h->root.root.string; 7100 1.3 christos } 7101 1.3 christos 7102 1.7 christos if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec)) 7103 1.3 christos { 7104 1.3 christos /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections, 7105 1.3 christos or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the 7106 1.3 christos section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */ 7107 1.3 christos howto = NULL; 7108 1.3 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max) 7109 1.3 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]; 7110 1.1 christos 7111 1.1 christos _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section, 7112 1.3 christos contents, rel->r_offset); 7113 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset; 7114 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = 0; 7115 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = 0; 7116 1.1 christos 7117 1.1 christos /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against 7118 1.1 christos symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for 7119 1.1 christos non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the 7120 1.1 christos eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */ 7121 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) 7122 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)) 7123 1.3 christos wrel--; 7124 1.3 christos 7125 1.3 christos continue; 7126 1.1 christos } 7127 1.1 christos 7128 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) 7129 1.1 christos { 7130 1.1 christos if (got2 != NULL 7131 1.1 christos && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 7132 1.1 christos && rel->r_addend != 0) 7133 1.1 christos { 7134 1.1 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the 7135 1.1 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */ 7136 1.1 christos rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset; 7137 1.1 christos } 7138 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT 7139 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24 7140 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX) 7141 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc; 7142 1.1 christos } 7143 1.1 christos 7144 1.1 christos /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs 7145 1.1 christos based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit 7146 1.1 christos RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible 7147 1.1 christos for the final instruction stream. */ 7148 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0; 7149 1.1 christos tls_gd = 0; 7150 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 7151 1.1 christos tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask; 7152 1.1 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL) 7153 1.1 christos { 7154 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 7155 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks; 7156 1.1 christos local_plt 7157 1.1 christos = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 7158 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 7159 1.1 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx]; 7160 1.1 christos } 7161 1.1 christos 7162 1.1 christos /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */ 7163 1.1 christos if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3) 7164 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3) 7165 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3) 7166 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3) 7167 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3) 7168 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3) 7169 1.7 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3) 7170 1.3 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3)) 7171 1.1 christos abort (); 7172 1.1 christos switch (r_type) 7173 1.7 christos { 7174 1.3 christos default: 7175 1.1 christos break; 7176 1.1 christos 7177 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: 7178 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: 7179 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 7180 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0 7181 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7182 1.10 christos { 7183 1.10 christos bfd_vma insn; 7184 1.1 christos 7185 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 7186 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7187 1.7 christos insn &= 31 << 21; 7188 1.1 christos insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */ 7189 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, 7190 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7191 1.7 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; 7192 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7193 1.1 christos } 7194 1.1 christos break; 7195 1.1 christos 7196 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS: 7197 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 7198 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0 7199 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 7200 1.1 christos { 7201 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn; 7202 1.1 christos 7203 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset); 7204 1.10 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2); 7205 1.10 christos if (insn == 0) 7206 1.1 christos abort (); 7207 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset); 7208 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; 7209 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7210 1.1 christos 7211 1.10 christos /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now 7212 1.10 christos PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */ 7213 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset; 7214 1.1 christos } 7215 1.1 christos break; 7216 1.1 christos 7217 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: 7218 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: 7219 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE; 7220 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0 7221 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7222 1.1 christos goto tls_gdld_hi; 7223 1.1 christos break; 7224 1.1 christos 7225 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: 7226 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: 7227 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0 7228 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7229 1.1 christos { 7230 1.9 christos tls_gdld_hi: 7231 1.10 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0) 7232 1.10 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3) 7233 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16); 7234 1.1 christos else 7235 1.1 christos { 7236 1.1 christos rel->r_offset -= d_offset; 7237 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset); 7238 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE; 7239 1.10 christos } 7240 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7241 1.1 christos } 7242 1.1 christos break; 7243 1.1 christos 7244 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: 7245 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: 7246 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE; 7247 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0 7248 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7249 1.1 christos goto tls_ldgd_opt; 7250 1.1 christos break; 7251 1.9 christos 7252 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: 7253 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: 7254 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0 7255 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7256 1.3 christos { 7257 1.3 christos unsigned int insn1, insn2; 7258 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset; 7259 1.3 christos 7260 1.7 christos tls_ldgd_opt: 7261 1.3 christos offset = (bfd_vma) -1; 7262 1.1 christos /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark 7263 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call 7264 1.1 christos stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next 7265 1.3 christos reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with 7266 1.9 christos the current reloc. Edit both insns. */ 7267 1.10 christos if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr 7268 1.10 christos && rel + 1 < relend 7269 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1, 7270 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr)) 7271 1.1 christos offset = rel[1].r_offset; 7272 1.7 christos /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep 7273 1.1 christos the destination reg. It may be something other than 7274 1.1 christos the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by 7275 1.1 christos intervening code. */ 7276 1.1 christos insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 7277 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7278 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0) 7279 1.1 christos { 7280 1.1 christos /* IE */ 7281 1.3 christos insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16); 7282 1.3 christos insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */ 7283 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1 7284 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4)) 7285 1.1 christos { 7286 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE); 7287 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */ 7288 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset); 7289 1.1 christos } 7290 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3) 7291 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16); 7292 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7293 1.1 christos } 7294 1.1 christos else 7295 1.1 christos { 7296 1.1 christos /* LE */ 7297 1.1 christos insn1 &= 0x1f << 21; 7298 1.1 christos insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */ 7299 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0) 7300 1.1 christos { 7301 1.10 christos /* Was an LD reloc. */ 7302 1.10 christos for (r_symndx = 0; 7303 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info; 7304 1.1 christos r_symndx++) 7305 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec) 7306 1.1 christos break; 7307 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info) 7308 1.7 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF; 7309 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET; 7310 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF) 7311 1.7 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value 7312 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset 7313 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma); 7314 1.1 christos } 7315 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; 7316 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7317 1.3 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1 7318 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4)) 7319 1.1 christos { 7320 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO); 7321 1.1 christos rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset; 7322 1.1 christos rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend; 7323 1.7 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */ 7324 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset); 7325 1.10 christos } 7326 1.1 christos } 7327 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1, 7328 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7329 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0) 7330 1.7 christos { 7331 1.7 christos /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over 7332 1.7 christos in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */ 7333 1.7 christos goto again; 7334 1.7 christos } 7335 1.7 christos } 7336 1.7 christos break; 7337 1.9 christos 7338 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD: 7339 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0 7340 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend 7341 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 7342 1.1 christos { 7343 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2; 7344 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset; 7345 1.1 christos 7346 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info))) 7347 1.1 christos { 7348 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset); 7349 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE); 7350 1.1 christos break; 7351 1.7 christos } 7352 1.1 christos 7353 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0) 7354 1.1 christos { 7355 1.1 christos /* IE */ 7356 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE; 7357 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */ 7358 1.1 christos } 7359 1.7 christos else 7360 1.10 christos { 7361 1.10 christos /* LE */ 7362 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; 7363 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset; 7364 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */ 7365 1.7 christos } 7366 1.7 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type); 7367 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset); 7368 1.7 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */ 7369 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset); 7370 1.7 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE); 7371 1.7 christos } 7372 1.1 christos break; 7373 1.1 christos 7374 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD: 7375 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0 7376 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend 7377 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 7378 1.1 christos { 7379 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2; 7380 1.1 christos 7381 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info))) 7382 1.1 christos { 7383 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset); 7384 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE); 7385 1.1 christos break; 7386 1.1 christos } 7387 1.1 christos 7388 1.7 christos for (r_symndx = 0; 7389 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info; 7390 1.1 christos r_symndx++) 7391 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec) 7392 1.1 christos break; 7393 1.3 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info) 7394 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF; 7395 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET; 7396 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF) 7397 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value 7398 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset 7399 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma); 7400 1.1 christos 7401 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO); 7402 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset; 7403 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */ 7404 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, 7405 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7406 1.1 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */ 7407 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset); 7408 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE); 7409 1.7 christos goto again; 7410 1.1 christos } 7411 1.1 christos break; 7412 1.1 christos } 7413 1.1 christos 7414 1.10 christos /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */ 7415 1.10 christos branch_bit = 0; 7416 1.10 christos switch (r_type) 7417 1.1 christos { 7418 1.10 christos default: 7419 1.10 christos break; 7420 1.10 christos 7421 1.1 christos /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */ 7422 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN: 7423 1.10 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 7424 1.10 christos branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 7425 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */ 7426 1.10 christos 7427 1.10 christos /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */ 7428 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN: 7429 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 7430 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 7431 1.10 christos { 7432 1.7 christos unsigned int insn; 7433 1.7 christos 7434 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset); 7435 1.10 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 7436 1.10 christos insn |= branch_bit; 7437 1.10 christos 7438 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset 7439 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset 7440 1.10 christos + input_section->output_section->vma); 7441 1.10 christos 7442 1.10 christos /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */ 7443 1.10 christos if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0) 7444 1.10 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 7445 1.10 christos 7446 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset); 7447 1.10 christos } 7448 1.10 christos break; 7449 1.10 christos 7450 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA: 7451 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7452 1.10 christos { 7453 1.10 christos unsigned int insn; 7454 1.10 christos 7455 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 7456 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7457 1.10 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 7458 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0) 7459 1.1 christos { 7460 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)) 7461 1.3 christos { 7462 1.3 christos /* Convert addis to lis. */ 7463 1.3 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16); 7464 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, 7465 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7466 1.3 christos } 7467 1.3 christos } 7468 1.3 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 7469 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo 7470 1.3 christos (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"), 7471 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 7472 1.3 christos "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn); 7473 1.10 christos } 7474 1.10 christos break; 7475 1.3 christos } 7476 1.7 christos 7477 1.3 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 7478 1.9 christos && h != NULL 7479 1.3 christos && !h->def_regular 7480 1.3 christos && h->protected_def 7481 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha 7482 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo 7483 1.3 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0) 7484 1.3 christos { 7485 1.3 christos /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected 7486 1.3 christos variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */ 7487 1.3 christos unsigned int insn; 7488 1.3 christos 7489 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA 7490 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7491 1.3 christos { 7492 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 7493 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7494 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26) 7495 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */) 7496 1.3 christos { 7497 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p; 7498 1.7 christos bfd_vma off; 7499 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_addr; 7500 1.3 christos 7501 1.3 christos p = (contents + input_section->size 7502 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size 7503 1.3 christos - relax_info->picfixup_size 7504 1.7 christos + picfixup_size); 7505 1.7 christos off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7506 1.3 christos if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0) 7507 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo 7508 1.3 christos (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"), 7509 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset); 7510 1.3 christos 7511 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off, 7512 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7513 1.3 christos got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma 7514 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset 7515 1.3 christos + (h->got.offset & ~1)); 7516 1.3 christos wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset; 7517 1.3 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA); 7518 1.3 christos wrel->r_addend = got_addr; 7519 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff; 7520 1.3 christos insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff; 7521 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p); 7522 1.3 christos 7523 1.3 christos /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */ 7524 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff; 7525 1.3 christos insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26; 7526 1.3 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5; 7527 1.3 christos insn |= got_addr & 0xffff; 7528 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4); 7529 1.3 christos 7530 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8); 7531 1.7 christos picfixup_size += 12; 7532 1.7 christos 7533 1.7 christos /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs 7534 1.7 christos output is reasonable. */ 7535 1.3 christos memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel)); 7536 1.3 christos wrel++, rel++; 7537 1.10 christos rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4; 7538 1.10 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO); 7539 1.10 christos rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend; 7540 1.3 christos 7541 1.7 christos /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output 7542 1.3 christos dynamic reloc. */ 7543 1.9 christos r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; 7544 1.9 christos } 7545 1.9 christos else 7546 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler 7547 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7548 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: " 7549 1.9 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"), 7550 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset, 7551 1.9 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn); 7552 1.9 christos } 7553 1.9 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO 7554 1.9 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, 7555 1.9 christos rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 7556 1.9 christos { 7557 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 7558 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 7559 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */ 7560 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */ 7561 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */ 7562 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */ 7563 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */ 7564 1.10 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */ 7565 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */ 7566 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */ 7567 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */ 7568 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */ 7569 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */ 7570 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */ 7571 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */ 7572 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */ 7573 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */ 7574 1.3 christos && (insn & 3) != 1) 7575 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */ 7576 1.3 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))) 7577 1.1 christos { 7578 1.10 christos /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */ 7579 1.1 christos relocation = 0; 7580 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 7581 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type); 7582 1.1 christos } 7583 1.1 christos else 7584 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 7585 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7586 1.1 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: " 7587 1.1 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"), 7588 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset, 7589 1.1 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn); 7590 1.1 christos } 7591 1.1 christos } 7592 1.1 christos 7593 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL; 7594 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks) 7595 1.1 christos { 7596 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 7597 1.1 christos 7598 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 7599 1.3 christos { 7600 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 7601 1.7 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist; 7602 1.7 christos } 7603 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL 7604 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 7605 1.1 christos { 7606 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 7607 1.7 christos 7608 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets 7609 1.7 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 7610 1.7 christos ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx; 7611 1.1 christos } 7612 1.1 christos 7613 1.1 christos ent = NULL; 7614 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL 7615 1.1 christos && (!bfd_link_pic (info) 7616 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type) 7617 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 7618 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 7619 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)) 7620 1.7 christos { 7621 1.7 christos addend = 0; 7622 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 7623 1.7 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 7624 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO 7625 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI 7626 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)) 7627 1.7 christos addend = rel->r_addend; 7628 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend); 7629 1.7 christos } 7630 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL) 7631 1.7 christos { 7632 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 7633 1.7 christos && ent->sec != got2 7634 1.7 christos && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW 7635 1.7 christos && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 7636 1.1 christos || h == NULL 7637 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)) 7638 1.10 christos { 7639 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub 7640 1.1 christos for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in 7641 1.3 christos finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and 7642 1.3 christos apparently are using code compiled with 7643 1.1 christos -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code 7644 1.1 christos gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend 7645 1.1 christos whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or 7646 1.1 christos is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far 7647 1.7 christos into .got2). */ 7648 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo 7649 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7650 1.1 christos (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"), 7651 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name); 7652 1.1 christos } 7653 1.1 christos 7654 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 7655 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW 7656 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 7657 1.1 christos || h == NULL 7658 1.7 christos || h->dynindx == -1) 7659 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma 7660 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset 7661 1.1 christos + (ent->glink_offset & ~1)); 7662 1.1 christos else 7663 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma 7664 1.10 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset 7665 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset); 7666 1.10 christos } 7667 1.10 christos } 7668 1.10 christos 7669 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend; 7670 1.10 christos save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc; 7671 1.10 christos howto = NULL; 7672 1.1 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max) 7673 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]; 7674 1.10 christos 7675 1.3 christos tls_type = 0; 7676 1.1 christos switch (r_type) 7677 1.1 christos { 7678 1.1 christos default: 7679 1.1 christos de_fault: 7680 1.1 christos if (howto) 7681 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7682 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"), 7683 1.1 christos input_bfd, howto->name); 7684 1.3 christos else 7685 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7686 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"), 7687 1.1 christos input_bfd, r_type); 7688 1.1 christos 7689 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 7690 1.1 christos ret = false; 7691 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc; 7692 1.1 christos 7693 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE: 7694 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS: 7695 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD: 7696 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD: 7697 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: 7698 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT: 7699 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY: 7700 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc; 7701 1.1 christos 7702 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's 7703 1.1 christos address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the 7704 1.1 christos symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the 7705 1.1 christos symbol and put the symbol value there. */ 7706 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: 7707 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: 7708 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: 7709 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: 7710 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD; 7711 1.1 christos goto dogot; 7712 1.1 christos 7713 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: 7714 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: 7715 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: 7716 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: 7717 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD; 7718 1.1 christos goto dogot; 7719 1.1 christos 7720 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: 7721 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: 7722 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: 7723 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: 7724 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL; 7725 1.1 christos goto dogot; 7726 1.1 christos 7727 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: 7728 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: 7729 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: 7730 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: 7731 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL; 7732 1.1 christos goto dogot; 7733 1.1 christos 7734 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16: 7735 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO: 7736 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI: 7737 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA: 7738 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0; 7739 1.1 christos dogot: 7740 1.7 christos { 7741 1.7 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global 7742 1.7 christos offset table. */ 7743 1.7 christos bfd_vma off; 7744 1.1 christos bfd_vma *offp; 7745 1.1 christos unsigned long indx; 7746 1.1 christos 7747 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL) 7748 1.1 christos abort (); 7749 1.1 christos 7750 1.1 christos indx = 0; 7751 1.1 christos if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD) 7752 1.10 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 7753 1.1 christos offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset; 7754 1.1 christos else if (h != NULL) 7755 1.1 christos { 7756 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created 7757 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1 7758 1.1 christos || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h) 7759 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)) 7760 1.1 christos /* This is actually a static link, or it is a 7761 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined 7762 1.1 christos locally, or the symbol was forced to be local 7763 1.1 christos because of a version file. */ 7764 1.1 christos ; 7765 1.1 christos else 7766 1.1 christos { 7767 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx; 7768 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 7769 1.1 christos } 7770 1.1 christos offp = &h->got.offset; 7771 1.7 christos } 7772 1.7 christos else 7773 1.9 christos { 7774 1.7 christos if (local_got_offsets == NULL) 7775 1.1 christos abort (); 7776 1.1 christos offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx]; 7777 1.1 christos } 7778 1.9 christos 7779 1.9 christos /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the 7780 1.1 christos least significant bit to record whether we have already 7781 1.1 christos processed this entry. */ 7782 1.1 christos off = *offp; 7783 1.1 christos if ((off & 1) != 0) 7784 1.1 christos off &= ~1; 7785 1.1 christos else 7786 1.1 christos { 7787 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 7788 1.1 christos ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL 7789 1.1 christos | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE) 7790 1.1 christos : 0); 7791 1.1 christos 7792 1.1 christos if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset) 7793 1.1 christos tls_m = TLS_LD; 7794 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0 7795 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 7796 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD; 7797 1.1 christos 7798 1.1 christos /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym. 7799 1.1 christos Initialize them all. */ 7800 1.1 christos do 7801 1.1 christos { 7802 1.1 christos int tls_ty = 0; 7803 1.9 christos 7804 1.1 christos if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0) 7805 1.1 christos { 7806 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD; 7807 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD; 7808 1.1 christos } 7809 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0) 7810 1.7 christos { 7811 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD; 7812 1.7 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_GD; 7813 1.9 christos } 7814 1.9 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0) 7815 1.7 christos { 7816 1.10 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL; 7817 1.10 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL; 7818 1.10 christos } 7819 1.10 christos else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0) 7820 1.1 christos { 7821 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL; 7822 1.1 christos tls_m = 0; 7823 1.3 christos } 7824 1.7 christos 7825 1.7 christos /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */ 7826 1.7 christos if (indx != 0 7827 1.7 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info) 7828 1.7 christos && (h == NULL 7829 1.7 christos || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)) 7830 1.7 christos && !(tls_ty != 0 7831 1.7 christos && bfd_link_executable (info) 7832 1.7 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 7833 1.1 christos && (h != NULL 7834 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root) 7835 1.1 christos : sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS))) 7836 1.1 christos { 7837 1.1 christos asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot; 7838 1.1 christos 7839 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL) 7840 1.11 christos { 7841 1.11 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt; 7842 1.11 christos if (indx == 0) 7843 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 7844 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h)) 7845 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 7846 1.1 christos } 7847 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma 7848 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset 7849 1.1 christos + off); 7850 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0; 7851 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD)) 7852 1.1 christos { 7853 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32); 7854 1.1 christos if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD)) 7855 1.1 christos { 7856 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, 7857 1.1 christos &outrel, 7858 1.1 christos rsec)); 7859 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += 4; 7860 1.1 christos outrel.r_info 7861 1.1 christos = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32); 7862 1.3 christos } 7863 1.3 christos } 7864 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL)) 7865 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32); 7866 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)) 7867 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32); 7868 1.1 christos else if (indx != 0) 7869 1.11 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT); 7870 1.11 christos else if (ifunc != NULL) 7871 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE); 7872 1.1 christos else 7873 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE); 7874 1.1 christos if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) 7875 1.1 christos { 7876 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend += relocation; 7877 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) 7878 1.1 christos { 7879 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL) 7880 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0; 7881 1.3 christos else 7882 1.3 christos outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma; 7883 1.3 christos } 7884 1.3 christos } 7885 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, 7886 1.7 christos &outrel, rsec)); 7887 1.7 christos } 7888 1.7 christos 7889 1.7 christos /* Init the .got section contents if we're not 7890 1.3 christos emitting a reloc. */ 7891 1.3 christos else 7892 1.1 christos { 7893 1.7 christos bfd_vma value = relocation; 7894 1.1 christos 7895 1.7 christos if (tls_ty != 0) 7896 1.7 christos { 7897 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL) 7898 1.1 christos value = 0; 7899 1.1 christos else 7900 1.7 christos { 7901 1.7 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_LD) 7902 1.1 christos value = 0; 7903 1.1 christos else 7904 1.1 christos value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET; 7905 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL) 7906 1.1 christos value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET; 7907 1.1 christos } 7908 1.1 christos 7909 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD)) 7910 1.1 christos { 7911 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, 7912 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4); 7913 1.1 christos value = 1; 7914 1.1 christos } 7915 1.1 christos } 7916 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, 7917 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off); 7918 1.1 christos } 7919 1.1 christos 7920 1.1 christos off += 4; 7921 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD)) 7922 1.9 christos off += 4; 7923 1.1 christos } 7924 1.1 christos while (tls_m != 0); 7925 1.1 christos 7926 1.1 christos off = *offp; 7927 1.1 christos *offp = off | 1; 7928 1.1 christos } 7929 1.1 christos 7930 1.1 christos if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2) 7931 1.1 christos abort (); 7932 1.1 christos 7933 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0) 7934 1.1 christos { 7935 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) 7936 1.1 christos { 7937 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0 7938 1.3 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 7939 1.3 christos off += 8; 7940 1.3 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD)) 7941 1.7 christos { 7942 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0) 7943 1.1 christos off += 8; 7944 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL)) 7945 1.1 christos { 7946 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0) 7947 1.1 christos off += 4; 7948 1.1 christos } 7949 1.1 christos } 7950 1.1 christos } 7951 1.1 christos } 7952 1.7 christos 7953 1.7 christos /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */ 7954 1.1 christos if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) 7955 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc; 7956 1.1 christos 7957 1.1 christos relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma 7958 1.3 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset 7959 1.1 christos + off 7960 1.3 christos - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot)); 7961 1.1 christos 7962 1.1 christos /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense. 7963 1.1 christos x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is 7964 1.1 christos generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the 7965 1.1 christos got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */ 7966 1.6 christos if (addend != 0) 7967 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo 7968 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 7969 1.6 christos (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"), 7970 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 7971 1.10 christos howto->name, 7972 1.3 christos sym_name); 7973 1.1 christos } 7974 1.7 christos break; 7975 1.7 christos 7976 1.7 christos /* Relocations that need no special processing. */ 7977 1.7 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC: 7978 1.7 christos /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation 7979 1.7 christos at a symbol not in this object. */ 7980 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc) 7981 1.7 christos { 7982 1.7 christos (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info, 7983 1.7 christos h->root.root.string, 7984 1.7 christos input_bfd, 7985 1.7 christos input_section, 7986 1.7 christos rel->r_offset, 7987 1.7 christos true); 7988 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc; 7989 1.1 christos } 7990 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info)) 7991 1.1 christos { 7992 1.1 christos /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since 7993 1.1 christos the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More 7994 1.1 christos seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call 7995 1.3 christos stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to 7996 1.3 christos access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is 7997 1.1 christos local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking 7998 1.1 christos -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is 7999 1.1 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */ 8000 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8001 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"), 8002 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8003 1.1 christos h->root.root.string); 8004 1.1 christos } 8005 1.1 christos break; 8006 1.1 christos 8007 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16: 8008 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: 8009 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: 8010 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: 8011 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL) 8012 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET; 8013 1.1 christos break; 8014 1.1 christos 8015 1.7 christos /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared 8016 1.1 christos object. */ 8017 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16: 8018 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO: 8019 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI: 8020 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 8021 1.3 christos if (h != NULL 8022 1.3 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak 8023 1.1 christos && h->dynindx == -1 8024 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 8025 1.7 christos { 8026 1.1 christos /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol 8027 1.1 christos resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since 8028 1.1 christos code using weak externs ought to check that they are 8029 1.3 christos defined before using them. */ 8030 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset; 8031 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p); 8032 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2); 8033 1.1 christos if (insn != 0) 8034 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p); 8035 1.3 christos break; 8036 1.1 christos } 8037 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL) 8038 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET; 8039 1.1 christos /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared 8040 1.1 christos libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in 8041 1.1 christos DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */ 8042 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 8043 1.1 christos 8044 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32: 8045 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL) 8046 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET; 8047 1.3 christos goto dodyn; 8048 1.1 christos 8049 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32: 8050 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL) 8051 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET; 8052 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 8053 1.1 christos 8054 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32: 8055 1.1 christos relocation = 1; 8056 1.1 christos addend = 0; 8057 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 8058 1.1 christos 8059 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16: 8060 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO: 8061 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI: 8062 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA: 8063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA: 8064 1.1 christos break; 8065 1.1 christos 8066 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32: 8067 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot) 8068 1.1 christos break; 8069 1.1 christos /* fall through */ 8070 1.1 christos 8071 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32: 8072 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16: 8073 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO: 8074 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI: 8075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA: 8076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32: 8077 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16: 8078 1.1 christos goto dodyn; 8079 1.1 christos 8080 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8: 8081 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15: 8082 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24: 8083 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24: 8084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14: 8085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN: 8086 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN: 8087 1.1 christos /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be 8088 1.1 christos handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */ 8089 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h) 8090 1.1 christos || h == htab->elf.hgot) 8091 1.7 christos break; 8092 1.7 christos /* fall through */ 8093 1.10 christos 8094 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24: 8095 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14: 8096 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN: 8097 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN: 8098 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info)) 8099 1.1 christos break; 8100 1.3 christos /* fall through */ 8101 1.7 christos 8102 1.7 christos dodyn: 8103 1.1 christos if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 8104 1.1 christos || is_vxworks_tls) 8105 1.1 christos break; 8106 1.1 christos 8107 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 8108 1.1 christos ? ((h == NULL 8109 1.1 christos || h->dyn_relocs != NULL) 8110 1.1 christos && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h)) 8111 1.1 christos || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))) 8112 1.1 christos : (h != NULL 8113 1.1 christos && h->dyn_relocs != NULL)) 8114 1.1 christos { 8115 1.1 christos int skip; 8116 1.1 christos asection *sreloc; 8117 1.1 christos long indx = 0; 8118 1.1 christos 8119 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 8120 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to " 8121 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n", 8122 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string 8123 1.9 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>")); 8124 1.9 christos #endif 8125 1.9 christos 8126 1.9 christos /* When generating a shared object, these relocations 8127 1.9 christos are copied into the output file to be resolved at run 8128 1.9 christos time. */ 8129 1.9 christos skip = 0; 8130 1.9 christos outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, 8131 1.1 christos input_section, 8132 1.1 christos rel->r_offset); 8133 1.7 christos if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1 8134 1.1 christos || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2) 8135 1.7 christos skip = (int) outrel.r_offset; 8136 1.7 christos outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma 8137 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset); 8138 1.7 christos 8139 1.1 christos /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */ 8140 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0) 8141 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0)) 8142 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32; 8143 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0) 8144 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0)) 8145 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16; 8146 1.1 christos 8147 1.1 christos if (skip) 8148 1.1 christos memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel); 8149 1.1 christos else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)) 8150 1.1 christos { 8151 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx; 8152 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1); 8153 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 8154 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type); 8155 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend; 8156 1.1 christos } 8157 1.1 christos else 8158 1.1 christos { 8159 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend; 8160 1.1 christos 8161 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32) 8162 1.7 christos { 8163 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL) 8164 1.1 christos { 8165 1.1 christos /* If we get here when building a static 8166 1.1 christos executable, then the libc startup function 8167 1.1 christos responsible for applying indirect function 8168 1.10 christos relocations is going to complain about 8169 1.1 christos the reloc type. 8170 1.1 christos If we get here when building a dynamic 8171 1.1 christos executable, it will be because we have 8172 1.1 christos a text relocation. The dynamic loader 8173 1.1 christos will set the text segment writable and 8174 1.1 christos non-executable to apply text relocations. 8175 1.10 christos So we'll segfault when trying to run the 8176 1.1 christos indirection function to resolve the reloc. */ 8177 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo 8178 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8179 1.1 christos (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect " 8180 1.1 christos "function %s unsupported\n"), 8181 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8182 1.1 christos howto->name, 8183 1.1 christos sym_name); 8184 1.1 christos ret = false; 8185 1.1 christos } 8186 1.1 christos else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec)) 8187 1.1 christos ; 8188 1.9 christos else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL) 8189 1.9 christos { 8190 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 8191 1.9 christos ret = false; 8192 1.9 christos } 8193 1.9 christos else 8194 1.1 christos { 8195 1.1 christos asection *osec; 8196 1.9 christos 8197 1.9 christos /* We are turning this relocation into one 8198 1.9 christos against a section symbol. It would be 8199 1.9 christos proper to subtract the symbol's value, 8200 1.9 christos osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend, 8201 1.9 christos but ld.so expects buggy relocs. 8202 1.1 christos FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */ 8203 1.9 christos osec = sec->output_section; 8204 1.9 christos if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0) 8205 1.9 christos { 8206 1.9 christos osec = htab->elf.tls_sec; 8207 1.9 christos indx = 0; 8208 1.9 christos } 8209 1.1 christos else 8210 1.1 christos { 8211 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx; 8212 1.1 christos if (indx == 0) 8213 1.1 christos { 8214 1.1 christos osec = htab->elf.text_index_section; 8215 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx; 8216 1.1 christos } 8217 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0); 8218 1.1 christos } 8219 1.7 christos 8220 1.7 christos /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs. 8221 1.7 christos Don't leave the symbol value in the 8222 1.7 christos addend for them. */ 8223 1.7 christos if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type)) 8224 1.7 christos outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma; 8225 1.7 christos } 8226 1.7 christos 8227 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type); 8228 1.7 christos } 8229 1.10 christos else if (ifunc != NULL) 8230 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE); 8231 1.11 christos else 8232 1.11 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE); 8233 1.1 christos } 8234 1.1 christos 8235 1.3 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc; 8236 1.1 christos if (ifunc) 8237 1.7 christos { 8238 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt; 8239 1.7 christos if (indx == 0) 8240 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 8241 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h)) 8242 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 8243 1.1 christos } 8244 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL) 8245 1.1 christos return false; 8246 1.1 christos 8247 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &outrel, 8248 1.1 christos sreloc)); 8249 1.1 christos 8250 1.1 christos if (skip == -1) 8251 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc; 8252 1.1 christos 8253 1.1 christos /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory 8254 1.1 christos so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */ 8255 1.1 christos if (!skip) 8256 1.1 christos { 8257 1.3 christos relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0; 8258 1.1 christos addend = 0; 8259 1.1 christos break; 8260 1.1 christos } 8261 1.1 christos } 8262 1.1 christos break; 8263 1.1 christos 8264 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT: 8265 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24: 8266 1.1 christos if (h != NULL) 8267 1.7 christos { 8268 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 8269 1.1 christos bfd_vma got2_addend = 0; 8270 1.1 christos 8271 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24) 8272 1.1 christos { 8273 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 8274 1.10 christos got2_addend = addend; 8275 1.10 christos addend = 0; 8276 1.10 christos } 8277 1.10 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend); 8278 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW) 8279 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma 8280 1.10 christos + htab->glink->output_offset 8281 1.10 christos + ent->glink_offset); 8282 1.10 christos else 8283 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma 8284 1.3 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset 8285 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset); 8286 1.10 christos } 8287 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */ 8288 1.10 christos 8289 1.10 christos case R_PPC_RELAX: 8290 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info) 8291 1.10 christos ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12, 8292 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4) 8293 1.10 christos : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 8294 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4)) 8295 1.10 christos { 8296 1.10 christos const int *stub; 8297 1.10 christos size_t size; 8298 1.10 christos size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset; 8299 1.10 christos unsigned int insn; 8300 1.10 christos 8301 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 8302 1.1 christos { 8303 1.10 christos relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma 8304 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset 8305 1.10 christos + rel->r_offset - 4); 8306 1.3 christos stub = shared_stub_entry; 8307 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12); 8308 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8); 8309 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4); 8310 1.10 christos stub += 3; 8311 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3; 8312 1.10 christos } 8313 1.10 christos else 8314 1.10 christos { 8315 1.10 christos stub = stub_entry; 8316 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry); 8317 1.10 christos } 8318 1.10 christos 8319 1.10 christos relocation += addend; 8320 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) 8321 1.10 christos relocation = 0; 8322 1.10 christos 8323 1.10 christos /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */ 8324 1.10 christos insn = *stub++; 8325 1.10 christos insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff; 8326 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset); 8327 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4; 8328 1.10 christos 8329 1.10 christos insn = *stub++; 8330 1.10 christos insn |= relocation & 0xffff; 8331 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset); 8332 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4; 8333 1.10 christos size -= 2; 8334 1.10 christos 8335 1.10 christos while (size != 0) 8336 1.10 christos { 8337 1.10 christos insn = *stub++; 8338 1.10 christos --size; 8339 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset); 8340 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4; 8341 1.1 christos } 8342 1.1 christos 8343 1.1 christos /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop 8344 1.1 christos relocs to describe this relocation. */ 8345 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE); 8346 1.1 christos /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */ 8347 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset; 8348 1.10 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA); 8349 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend; 8350 1.1 christos memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel)); 8351 1.1 christos wrel++, rel++; 8352 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset += 4; 8353 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO); 8354 1.1 christos } 8355 1.1 christos else 8356 1.1 christos goto de_fault; 8357 1.1 christos continue; 8358 1.1 christos 8359 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */ 8360 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: 8361 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL); 8362 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym)) 8363 1.1 christos { 8364 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8365 1.1 christos break; 8366 1.1 christos } 8367 1.1 christos relocation 8368 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0], 8369 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel); 8370 1.1 christos addend = 0; 8371 1.1 christos break; 8372 1.1 christos 8373 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */ 8374 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: 8375 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL); 8376 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym)) 8377 1.1 christos { 8378 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8379 1.1 christos break; 8380 1.1 christos } 8381 1.9 christos relocation 8382 1.9 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1], 8383 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel); 8384 1.1 christos addend = 0; 8385 1.1 christos break; 8386 1.1 christos 8387 1.1 christos /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got 8388 1.1 christos section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating 8389 1.1 christos an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the 8390 1.3 christos AIX .toc section. */ 8391 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */ 8392 1.3 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL) 8393 1.3 christos { 8394 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8395 1.7 christos break; 8396 1.1 christos } 8397 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0 8398 1.1 christos || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0); 8399 1.1 christos 8400 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000; 8401 1.1 christos break; 8402 1.1 christos 8403 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24: 8404 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL) 8405 1.10 christos { 8406 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 8407 1.1 christos 8408 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, 8409 1.1 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0); 8410 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL 8411 1.7 christos || htab->elf.splt == NULL) 8412 1.7 christos { 8413 1.1 christos /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This 8414 1.1 christos happens when statically linking PIC code, or when 8415 1.1 christos using -Bsymbolic. */ 8416 1.1 christos } 8417 1.1 christos else 8418 1.1 christos { 8419 1.1 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the 8420 1.1 christos procedure linkage table. */ 8421 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 8422 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW) 8423 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma 8424 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset 8425 1.7 christos + ent->glink_offset); 8426 1.7 christos else 8427 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma 8428 1.7 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset 8429 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset); 8430 1.7 christos } 8431 1.7 christos } 8432 1.7 christos 8433 1.7 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the 8434 1.7 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. 8435 1.7 christos Don't apply it to the relocation field. */ 8436 1.7 christos addend = 0; 8437 1.7 christos break; 8438 1.7 christos 8439 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ: 8440 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL: 8441 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO: 8442 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI: 8443 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA: 8444 1.7 christos plt_list = NULL; 8445 1.7 christos if (h != NULL) 8446 1.7 christos plt_list = &h->plt.plist; 8447 1.7 christos else if (ifunc != NULL) 8448 1.7 christos plt_list = ifunc; 8449 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL) 8450 1.7 christos { 8451 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt; 8452 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets 8453 1.10 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info); 8454 1.7 christos plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx; 8455 1.7 christos } 8456 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8457 1.7 christos if (plt_list != NULL) 8458 1.7 christos { 8459 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 8460 1.7 christos 8461 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2, 8462 1.7 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0); 8463 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1) 8464 1.7 christos { 8465 1.7 christos asection *plt; 8466 1.7 christos 8467 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 8468 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.splt; 8469 1.7 christos if (use_local_plt (info, h)) 8470 1.7 christos { 8471 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL) 8472 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt; 8473 1.7 christos else 8474 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal; 8475 1.7 christos } 8476 1.7 christos relocation = (plt->output_section->vma 8477 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset 8478 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset); 8479 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 8480 1.1 christos { 8481 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0; 8482 1.1 christos 8483 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768) 8484 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend 8485 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma 8486 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset); 8487 1.1 christos else 8488 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot); 8489 1.1 christos relocation -= got; 8490 1.10 christos } 8491 1.1 christos } 8492 1.1 christos } 8493 1.1 christos addend = 0; 8494 1.1 christos break; 8495 1.9 christos 8496 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */ 8497 1.3 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16: 8498 1.1 christos { 8499 1.7 christos const char *name; 8500 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym; 8501 1.7 christos 8502 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL 8503 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL 8504 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda)) 8505 1.1 christos { 8506 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8507 1.1 christos break; 8508 1.1 christos } 8509 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda); 8510 1.1 christos 8511 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section); 8512 1.1 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0 8513 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)) 8514 1.1 christos { 8515 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler 8516 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8517 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is " 8518 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"), 8519 1.1 christos input_bfd, 8520 1.1 christos sym_name, 8521 1.10 christos howto->name, 8522 1.1 christos name); 8523 1.1 christos } 8524 1.1 christos } 8525 1.1 christos break; 8526 1.9 christos 8527 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */ 8528 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: 8529 1.1 christos { 8530 1.7 christos const char *name; 8531 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym; 8532 1.7 christos 8533 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL 8534 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL 8535 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda)) 8536 1.1 christos { 8537 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8538 1.1 christos break; 8539 1.1 christos } 8540 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda); 8541 1.1 christos 8542 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section); 8543 1.3 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0 8544 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)) 8545 1.10 christos { 8546 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler 8547 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8548 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is " 8549 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"), 8550 1.1 christos input_bfd, 8551 1.3 christos sym_name, 8552 1.10 christos howto->name, 8553 1.10 christos name); 8554 1.10 christos } 8555 1.10 christos } 8556 1.10 christos break; 8557 1.1 christos 8558 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A: 8559 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend; 8560 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8561 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8562 1.10 christos split16a_type, 8563 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8564 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8565 1.1 christos 8566 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D: 8567 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend; 8568 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8569 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8570 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8571 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8572 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8573 1.1 christos 8574 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A: 8575 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16; 8576 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8577 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8578 1.10 christos split16a_type, 8579 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8580 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8581 1.1 christos 8582 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D: 8583 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16; 8584 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8585 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8586 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8587 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8588 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8589 1.1 christos 8590 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A: 8591 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16; 8592 1.1 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8593 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8594 1.1 christos split16a_type, 8595 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8596 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8597 1.10 christos 8598 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D: 8599 1.10 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16; 8600 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8601 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation, 8602 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8603 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8604 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8605 1.10 christos 8606 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */ 8607 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21: 8608 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21: 8609 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: 8610 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: 8611 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 8612 1.1 christos { 8613 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange; 8614 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8615 1.10 christos } 8616 1.10 christos else 8617 1.10 christos { 8618 1.10 christos const char *name; 8619 1.10 christos int reg; 8620 1.10 christos unsigned int insn; 8621 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL; 8622 1.10 christos 8623 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL) 8624 1.10 christos { 8625 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8626 1.10 christos break; 8627 1.10 christos } 8628 1.10 christos 8629 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section); 8630 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0 8631 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0) 8632 1.10 christos { 8633 1.10 christos reg = 13; 8634 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym; 8635 1.10 christos } 8636 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0 8637 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0) 8638 1.10 christos { 8639 1.10 christos reg = 2; 8640 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym; 8641 1.10 christos } 8642 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0 8643 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0) 8644 1.10 christos { 8645 1.10 christos reg = 0; 8646 1.1 christos } 8647 1.10 christos else 8648 1.10 christos { 8649 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler 8650 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8651 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is " 8652 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"), 8653 1.10 christos input_bfd, 8654 1.10 christos sym_name, 8655 1.10 christos howto->name, 8656 1.1 christos name); 8657 1.10 christos 8658 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 8659 1.1 christos ret = false; 8660 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc; 8661 1.10 christos } 8662 1.10 christos 8663 1.10 christos if (sda != NULL) 8664 1.10 christos { 8665 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (sda)) 8666 1.10 christos { 8667 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8668 1.10 christos break; 8669 1.9 christos } 8670 1.10 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda); 8671 1.10 christos } 8672 1.10 christos 8673 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA) 8674 1.10 christos break; 8675 1.10 christos 8676 1.10 christos /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface 8677 1.3 christos version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 8678 1.10 christos operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and 8679 1.10 christos GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on 8680 1.10 christos a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file 8681 1.10 christos producers that possibly comply with the EABI in 8682 1.10 christos generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */ 8683 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21) 8684 1.10 christos rel->r_offset &= ~1; 8685 1.10 christos 8686 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset); 8687 1.10 christos if (reg == 0 8688 1.10 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 8689 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO)) 8690 1.10 christos { 8691 1.10 christos relocation = relocation + addend; 8692 1.10 christos addend = 0; 8693 1.10 christos 8694 1.10 christos /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */ 8695 1.10 christos insn &= 0x1f << 21; 8696 1.10 christos insn |= 28u << 26; 8697 1.10 christos 8698 1.10 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */ 8699 1.10 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */ 8700 1.10 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5; 8701 1.10 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */ 8702 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5; 8703 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */ 8704 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0x7ff; 8705 1.1 christos 8706 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset); 8707 1.1 christos 8708 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok; 8709 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 8710 1.10 christos && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000) 8711 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_overflow; 8712 1.10 christos goto report_reloc; 8713 1.10 christos } 8714 1.10 christos /* Fill in register field. */ 8715 1.10 christos insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT); 8716 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset); 8717 1.1 christos } 8718 1.10 christos break; 8719 1.10 christos 8720 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A: 8721 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D: 8722 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A: 8723 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D: 8724 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A: 8725 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D: 8726 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 8727 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange; 8728 1.10 christos else 8729 1.10 christos { 8730 1.10 christos bfd_vma value; 8731 1.10 christos const char *name; 8732 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL; 8733 1.10 christos 8734 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL) 8735 1.10 christos { 8736 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8737 1.10 christos break; 8738 1.10 christos } 8739 1.10 christos 8740 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section); 8741 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0 8742 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0) 8743 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym; 8744 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0 8745 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0) 8746 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym; 8747 1.10 christos else 8748 1.10 christos { 8749 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler 8750 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8751 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is " 8752 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"), 8753 1.1 christos input_bfd, 8754 1.10 christos sym_name, 8755 1.10 christos howto->name, 8756 1.10 christos name); 8757 1.10 christos 8758 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 8759 1.10 christos ret = false; 8760 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc; 8761 1.10 christos } 8762 1.10 christos 8763 1.10 christos if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda)) 8764 1.10 christos { 8765 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8766 1.10 christos break; 8767 1.10 christos } 8768 1.10 christos value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda); 8769 1.10 christos 8770 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A) 8771 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8772 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8773 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8774 1.10 christos split16a_type, 8775 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8776 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D) 8777 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8778 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8779 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8780 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8781 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8782 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A) 8783 1.10 christos { 8784 1.10 christos value = value >> 16; 8785 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8786 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8787 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8788 1.10 christos split16a_type, 8789 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8790 1.10 christos } 8791 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D) 8792 1.10 christos { 8793 1.10 christos value = value >> 16; 8794 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8795 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8796 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8797 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8798 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8799 1.10 christos } 8800 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A) 8801 1.10 christos { 8802 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16; 8803 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8804 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8805 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8806 1.1 christos split16a_type, 8807 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8808 1.10 christos } 8809 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D) 8810 1.10 christos { 8811 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16; 8812 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, 8813 1.10 christos rel->r_offset, 8814 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value, 8815 1.10 christos split16d_type, 8816 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup); 8817 1.7 christos } 8818 1.1 christos else 8819 1.1 christos abort (); 8820 1.1 christos } 8821 1.1 christos goto report_reloc; 8822 1.1 christos 8823 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20: 8824 1.1 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 8825 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange; 8826 1.1 christos else 8827 1.1 christos { 8828 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, 8829 1.1 christos relocation); 8830 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok; 8831 1.1 christos } 8832 1.1 christos goto report_reloc; 8833 1.1 christos 8834 1.1 christos /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */ 8835 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF: 8836 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO: 8837 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI: 8838 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA: 8839 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL) 8840 1.1 christos { 8841 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true; 8842 1.1 christos break; 8843 1.1 christos } 8844 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma; 8845 1.1 christos break; 8846 1.1 christos 8847 1.1 christos /* Negative relocations. */ 8848 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: 8849 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: 8850 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: 8851 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: 8852 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: 8853 1.7 christos addend -= 2 * relocation; 8854 1.7 christos break; 8855 1.7 christos 8856 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY: 8857 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT: 8858 1.10 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT: 8859 1.3 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE: 8860 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE: 8861 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32: 8862 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32: 8863 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30: 8864 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: 8865 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: 8866 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: 8867 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: 8868 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: 8869 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 8870 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"), 8871 1.10 christos input_bfd, howto->name); 8872 1.10 christos 8873 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation); 8874 1.10 christos ret = false; 8875 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc; 8876 1.10 christos } 8877 1.10 christos 8878 1.10 christos switch (r_type) 8879 1.10 christos { 8880 1.10 christos default: 8881 1.10 christos break; 8882 1.10 christos 8883 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 8884 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt 8885 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000 8886 1.10 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4)) 8887 1.10 christos 8888 1.10 christos { 8889 1.10 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3); 8890 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p); 8891 1.10 christos } 8892 1.10 christos break; 8893 1.10 christos 8894 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO: 8895 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt 8896 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000 8897 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4)) 8898 1.7 christos { 8899 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3); 8900 1.10 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p); 8901 1.10 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16); 8902 1.10 christos insn |= 2 << 16; 8903 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p); 8904 1.10 christos } 8905 1.10 christos break; 8906 1.10 christos } 8907 1.10 christos 8908 1.10 christos switch (r_type) 8909 1.10 christos { 8910 1.7 christos default: 8911 1.7 christos break; 8912 1.7 christos 8913 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL: 8914 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc) 8915 1.7 christos { 8916 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 8917 1.7 christos { 8918 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset; 8919 1.7 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p); 8920 1.7 christos insn &= 1; 8921 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p); 8922 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc; 8923 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_REL24; 8924 1.10 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]; 8925 1.10 christos } 8926 1.10 christos } 8927 1.10 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW) 8928 1.10 christos info->callbacks->einfo 8929 1.10 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"), 8930 1.10 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8931 1.7 christos howto->name); 8932 1.7 christos break; 8933 1.7 christos 8934 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ: 8935 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA: 8936 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO: 8937 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc) 8938 1.7 christos { 8939 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4)) 8940 1.1 christos { 8941 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3); 8942 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p); 8943 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false; 8944 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE; 8945 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]; 8946 1.1 christos } 8947 1.1 christos } 8948 1.3 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW) 8949 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo 8950 1.1 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"), 8951 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 8952 1.1 christos howto->name); 8953 1.1 christos break; 8954 1.1 christos } 8955 1.1 christos 8956 1.1 christos /* Do any further special processing. */ 8957 1.1 christos switch (r_type) 8958 1.1 christos { 8959 1.1 christos default: 8960 1.7 christos break; 8961 1.1 christos 8962 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA: 8963 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA: 8964 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA: 8965 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA: 8966 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA: 8967 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: 8968 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: 8969 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: 8970 1.1 christos /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol 8971 1.1 christos that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case, 8972 1.1 christos 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol 8973 1.1 christos alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */ 8974 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL) 8975 1.1 christos break; 8976 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */ 8977 1.1 christos 8978 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA: 8979 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA: 8980 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: 8981 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: 8982 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: 8983 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: 8984 1.1 christos /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set. 8985 1.1 christos Bits 0:15 are not used. */ 8986 1.1 christos addend += 0x8000; 8987 1.1 christos break; 8988 1.1 christos 8989 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16: 8990 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO: 8991 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16: 8992 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO: 8993 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16: 8994 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF: 8995 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO: 8996 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16: 8997 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: 8998 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16: 8999 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO: 9000 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: 9001 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: 9002 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: 9003 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: 9004 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: 9005 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: 9006 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: 9007 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: 9008 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4)) 9009 1.10 christos { 9010 1.10 christos /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with 9011 1.10 christos certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits 9012 1.10 christos that make up part of the insn opcode. */ 9013 1.10 christos unsigned int insn, mask, lobit; 9014 1.10 christos 9015 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, 9016 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset); 9017 1.10 christos mask = 0; 9018 1.10 christos if (is_insn_ds_form (insn)) 9019 1.10 christos mask = 3; 9020 1.10 christos else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn)) 9021 1.10 christos mask = 15; 9022 1.10 christos else 9023 1.1 christos break; 9024 1.1 christos relocation += addend; 9025 1.1 christos addend = insn & mask; 9026 1.1 christos lobit = mask & relocation; 9027 1.1 christos if (lobit != 0) 9028 1.1 christos { 9029 1.1 christos relocation ^= lobit; 9030 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo 9031 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 9032 1.1 christos (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"), 9033 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 9034 1.1 christos howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1); 9035 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 9036 1.1 christos ret = false; 9037 1.1 christos } 9038 1.1 christos } 9039 1.1 christos break; 9040 1.1 christos } 9041 1.1 christos 9042 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9043 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, " 9044 1.7 christos "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n", 9045 1.7 christos howto->name, 9046 1.1 christos (int) r_type, 9047 1.1 christos sym_name, 9048 1.1 christos r_symndx, 9049 1.10 christos (long) rel->r_offset, 9050 1.1 christos (long) addend); 9051 1.1 christos #endif 9052 1.3 christos 9053 1.3 christos if (unresolved_reloc 9054 1.3 christos && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0 9055 1.3 christos && h->def_dynamic) 9056 1.3 christos && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, 9057 1.10 christos rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1) 9058 1.10 christos { 9059 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo 9060 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 9061 1.3 christos (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"), 9062 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 9063 1.3 christos howto->name, 9064 1.3 christos sym_name); 9065 1.3 christos ret = false; 9066 1.3 christos } 9067 1.9 christos 9068 1.3 christos /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a 9069 1.9 christos few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should 9070 1.9 christos have different reloc types. */ 9071 1.9 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont 9072 1.3 christos && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff 9073 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0 9074 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4)) 9075 1.3 christos { 9076 1.3 christos enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed; 9077 1.3 christos 9078 1.3 christos if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0) 9079 1.3 christos { 9080 1.3 christos unsigned int insn; 9081 1.3 christos 9082 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3)); 9083 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */) 9084 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_bitfield; 9085 1.10 christos else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */ 9086 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */ 9087 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */) 9088 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_unsigned; 9089 1.3 christos } 9090 1.3 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain) 9091 1.3 christos { 9092 1.3 christos alt_howto = *howto; 9093 1.3 christos alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain; 9094 1.3 christos howto = &alt_howto; 9095 1.3 christos } 9096 1.3 christos } 9097 1.3 christos 9098 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA) 9099 1.3 christos { 9100 1.3 christos /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */ 9101 1.3 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4)) 9102 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange; 9103 1.3 christos else 9104 1.3 christos { 9105 1.3 christos unsigned int insn; 9106 1.1 christos 9107 1.10 christos relocation += addend; 9108 1.1 christos relocation -= (rel->r_offset 9109 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset 9110 1.1 christos + input_section->output_section->vma); 9111 1.1 christos relocation >>= 16; 9112 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset); 9113 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1; 9114 1.3 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15); 9115 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset); 9116 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok; 9117 1.3 christos } 9118 1.3 christos } 9119 1.6 christos else 9120 1.6 christos r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents, 9121 1.6 christos rel->r_offset, relocation, addend); 9122 1.1 christos 9123 1.1 christos report_reloc: 9124 1.1 christos if (r != bfd_reloc_ok) 9125 1.1 christos { 9126 1.7 christos if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow) 9127 1.7 christos { 9128 1.1 christos /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow 9129 1.1 christos on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */ 9130 1.10 christos if (!warned 9131 1.1 christos && !(h != NULL 9132 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak 9133 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined) 9134 1.3 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type))) 9135 1.3 christos info->callbacks->reloc_overflow 9136 1.3 christos (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name, 9137 1.3 christos rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset); 9138 1.3 christos } 9139 1.3 christos else 9140 1.3 christos { 9141 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo 9142 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 9143 1.3 christos (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"), 9144 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, 9145 1.3 christos howto->name, sym_name, (int) r); 9146 1.3 christos ret = false; 9147 1.3 christos } 9148 1.3 christos } 9149 1.3 christos copy_reloc: 9150 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel) 9151 1.3 christos *wrel = *rel; 9152 1.3 christos } 9153 1.3 christos 9154 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel) 9155 1.3 christos { 9156 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr; 9157 1.3 christos size_t deleted = rel - wrel; 9158 1.1 christos 9159 1.1 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section); 9160 1.1 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted; 9161 1.1 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0) 9162 1.1 christos { 9163 1.1 christos /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave 9164 1.3 christos one NONE reloc. 9165 1.3 christos ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */ 9166 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize; 9167 1.3 christos deleted -= 1; 9168 1.3 christos wrel++; 9169 1.3 christos } 9170 1.3 christos relend = wrel; 9171 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section); 9172 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted; 9173 1.3 christos input_section->reloc_count -= deleted; 9174 1.3 christos } 9175 1.3 christos 9176 1.3 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9177 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n"); 9178 1.3 christos #endif 9179 1.3 christos 9180 1.3 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET 9181 1.3 christos && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize 9182 1.3 christos && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0 9183 1.3 christos || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0)) 9184 1.3 christos { 9185 1.3 christos /* Branch around the trampolines. */ 9186 1.3 christos unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize; 9187 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize); 9188 1.3 christos } 9189 1.3 christos 9190 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround 9191 1.3 christos && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET 9192 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) 9193 1.3 christos || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power 9194 1.3 christos >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))) 9195 1.3 christos { 9196 1.3 christos bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr; 9197 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2; 9198 1.3 christos 9199 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0) 9200 1.3 christos { 9201 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p; 9202 1.3 christos unsigned int n; 9203 1.3 christos bfd_byte fill[4]; 9204 1.3 christos 9205 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill); 9206 1.3 christos p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size; 9207 1.3 christos n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2; 9208 1.3 christos while (n--) 9209 1.3 christos { 9210 1.3 christos memcpy (p, fill, 4); 9211 1.3 christos p += 4; 9212 1.3 christos } 9213 1.3 christos } 9214 1.3 christos 9215 1.10 christos /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a 9216 1.3 christos branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a 9217 1.3 christos branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by 9218 1.3 christos needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not 9219 1.3 christos wanting to touch data-in-text. */ 9220 1.3 christos 9221 1.10 christos start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma 9222 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset); 9223 1.3 christos end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size 9224 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size); 9225 1.3 christos for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4); 9226 1.3 christos addr < end_addr; 9227 1.3 christos addr += pagesize) 9228 1.3 christos { 9229 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr; 9230 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi; 9231 1.3 christos bool is_data; 9232 1.3 christos bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr; 9233 1.3 christos unsigned int insn; 9234 1.3 christos 9235 1.3 christos /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave 9236 1.3 christos the word alone. */ 9237 1.3 christos is_data = false; 9238 1.3 christos lo = relocs; 9239 1.3 christos hi = relend; 9240 1.10 christos rel = NULL; 9241 1.3 christos while (lo < hi) 9242 1.3 christos { 9243 1.3 christos rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2; 9244 1.3 christos if (rel->r_offset < offset) 9245 1.3 christos lo = rel + 1; 9246 1.3 christos else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3) 9247 1.3 christos hi = rel; 9248 1.3 christos else 9249 1.3 christos { 9250 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) 9251 1.3 christos { 9252 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32: 9253 1.3 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32: 9254 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL32: 9255 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30: 9256 1.3 christos is_data = true; 9257 1.3 christos break; 9258 1.3 christos default: 9259 1.3 christos break; 9260 1.3 christos } 9261 1.3 christos break; 9262 1.3 christos } 9263 1.3 christos } 9264 1.3 christos if (is_data) 9265 1.3 christos continue; 9266 1.3 christos 9267 1.3 christos /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional 9268 1.3 christos branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl), 9269 1.3 christos avoid the icache failure. 9270 1.3 christos 9271 1.3 christos The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary 9272 1.3 christos where stale instructions can be fetched from the next 9273 1.3 christos page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad 9274 1.3 christos instructions fails under certain circumstances. The 9275 1.3 christos unconditional branches: 9276 1.3 christos 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla, 9277 1.3 christos 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla, 9278 1.3 christos 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl, 9279 1.3 christos where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional, 9280 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is 9281 1.3 christos affected by these instructions. This happens even if the 9282 1.3 christos instruction is not executed. 9283 1.3 christos 9284 1.3 christos A bctr example: 9285 1.3 christos . 9286 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha 9287 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l 9288 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 9289 1.3 christos . bctr 9290 1.3 christos . nop 9291 1.3 christos . nop 9292 1.3 christos . new_page: 9293 1.3 christos . 9294 1.3 christos The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being 9295 1.9 christos ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the 9296 1.9 christos new page which might have stale instructions. If they 9297 1.7 christos fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the 9298 1.9 christos bctr executes. Either of the following modifications 9299 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first 9300 1.7 christos place: 9301 1.3 christos . 9302 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha 9303 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l 9304 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 mtctr 9 9305 1.3 christos . bctr bctr 9306 1.3 christos . nop b somewhere_else 9307 1.3 christos . b somewhere_else nop 9308 1.3 christos . new_page: new_page: 9309 1.3 christos . */ 9310 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset); 9311 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */ 9312 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/ 9313 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */ 9314 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26) 9315 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */ 9316 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */ 9317 1.3 christos continue; 9318 1.3 christos 9319 1.3 christos patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size 9320 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size); 9321 1.3 christos patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16; 9322 1.3 christos patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr; 9323 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset); 9324 1.3 christos 9325 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL 9326 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset >= offset 9327 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset < offset + 4) 9328 1.3 christos { 9329 1.3 christos asection *sreloc; 9330 1.3 christos 9331 1.3 christos /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the 9332 1.3 christos reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved 9333 1.3 christos location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */ 9334 1.3 christos if (rel + 1 != relend) 9335 1.3 christos { 9336 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel; 9337 1.3 christos 9338 1.3 christos /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */ 9339 1.3 christos memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel)); 9340 1.3 christos relend[-1] = tmp; 9341 1.3 christos } 9342 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset; 9343 1.3 christos 9344 1.3 christos /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */ 9345 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info)) 9346 1.3 christos { 9347 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16: 9348 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO: 9349 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI: 9350 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA: 9351 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset; 9352 1.3 christos break; 9353 1.3 christos default: 9354 1.3 christos break; 9355 1.3 christos } 9356 1.3 christos 9357 1.3 christos /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with 9358 1.3 christos non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too? 9359 1.3 christos If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */ 9360 1.3 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc; 9361 1.3 christos if (sreloc != NULL) 9362 1.3 christos { 9363 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend; 9364 1.3 christos bfd_vma soffset; 9365 1.3 christos 9366 1.3 christos slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents; 9367 1.3 christos shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count; 9368 1.3 christos soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma 9369 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset); 9370 1.3 christos while (slo < shi) 9371 1.3 christos { 9372 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2; 9373 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel, 9374 1.3 christos &outrel); 9375 1.3 christos if (outrel.r_offset < soffset) 9376 1.3 christos slo = srel + 1; 9377 1.3 christos else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3) 9378 1.3 christos shi = srel; 9379 1.3 christos else 9380 1.3 christos { 9381 1.3 christos if (srel + 1 != srelend) 9382 1.9 christos { 9383 1.3 christos memmove (srel, srel + 1, 9384 1.3 christos (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel)); 9385 1.3 christos srel = srelend - 1; 9386 1.3 christos } 9387 1.3 christos outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset; 9388 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, 9389 1.3 christos (bfd_byte *) srel); 9390 1.3 christos break; 9391 1.3 christos } 9392 1.3 christos } 9393 1.3 christos } 9394 1.3 christos } 9395 1.3 christos else 9396 1.3 christos rel = NULL; 9397 1.3 christos 9398 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */ 9399 1.3 christos && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */) 9400 1.3 christos { 9401 1.3 christos bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; 9402 1.3 christos 9403 1.3 christos delta += offset - patch_off; 9404 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL) 9405 1.3 christos delta = 0; 9406 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL) 9407 1.3 christos { 9408 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type; 9409 1.3 christos 9410 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info); 9411 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN) 9412 1.3 christos insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 9413 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN) 9414 1.3 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 9415 1.3 christos else 9416 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14); 9417 1.3 christos 9418 1.3 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN 9419 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN) 9420 1.3 christos && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000 9421 1.3 christos && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0) 9422 1.3 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT; 9423 1.3 christos } 9424 1.3 christos if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000) 9425 1.3 christos { 9426 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9427 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc), 9428 1.3 christos contents + patch_off); 9429 1.3 christos patch_off += 4; 9430 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9431 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc), 9432 1.3 christos contents + patch_off); 9433 1.3 christos patch_off += 4; 9434 1.3 christos } 9435 1.3 christos else 9436 1.3 christos { 9437 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL) 9438 1.3 christos { 9439 1.3 christos unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info); 9440 1.3 christos 9441 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += 8; 9442 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24); 9443 1.3 christos } 9444 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9445 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8, 9446 1.3 christos contents + patch_off); 9447 1.3 christos patch_off += 4; 9448 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9449 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc), 9450 1.3 christos contents + patch_off); 9451 1.3 christos patch_off += 4; 9452 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9453 1.3 christos B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc), 9454 1.3 christos contents + patch_off); 9455 1.3 christos patch_off += 4; 9456 1.1 christos } 9457 1.1 christos } 9458 1.1 christos else 9459 1.7 christos { 9460 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off); 9461 1.10 christos patch_off += 4; 9462 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 9463 1.1 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc), 9464 1.7 christos contents + patch_off); 9465 1.7 christos patch_off += 4; 9466 1.1 christos } 9467 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size); 9468 1.1 christos relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off; 9469 1.10 christos } 9470 1.1 christos } 9471 1.1 christos 9472 1.1 christos return ret; 9473 1.10 christos } 9474 1.10 christos 9475 1.1 christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */ 9477 1.1 christos 9478 1.1 christos static bool 9479 1.1 christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf) 9480 1.7 christos { 9481 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf; 9482 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 9483 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 9484 1.1 christos bool doneone; 9485 1.1 christos 9486 1.1 christos doneone = false; 9487 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 9488 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1) 9489 1.1 christos { 9490 1.1 christos bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h); 9491 1.1 christos 9492 1.1 christos if (!doneone) 9493 1.1 christos { 9494 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela; 9495 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc; 9496 1.10 christos bfd_vma reloc_index; 9497 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt; 9498 1.1 christos asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt; 9499 1.1 christos 9500 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn) 9501 1.1 christos reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4; 9502 1.1 christos else 9503 1.1 christos { 9504 1.1 christos reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size) 9505 1.3 christos / htab->plt_slot_size); 9506 1.1 christos if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 9507 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD) 9508 1.1 christos reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2; 9509 1.3 christos } 9510 1.1 christos 9511 1.7 christos /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table. 9512 1.1 christos Set it up. */ 9513 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn) 9514 1.7 christos { 9515 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_offset; 9516 1.7 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry; 9517 1.1 christos 9518 1.1 christos /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */ 9519 1.1 christos got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4; 9520 1.1 christos 9521 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */ 9522 1.7 christos plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry 9523 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry; 9524 1.7 christos 9525 1.7 christos /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */ 9526 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 9527 1.7 christos { 9528 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9529 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset), 9530 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0); 9531 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9532 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset), 9533 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4); 9534 1.1 christos } 9535 1.1 christos else 9536 1.1 christos { 9537 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot); 9538 1.1 christos 9539 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9540 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc), 9541 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0); 9542 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9543 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc), 9544 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4); 9545 1.1 christos } 9546 1.1 christos 9547 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2], 9548 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8); 9549 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3], 9550 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12); 9551 1.1 christos 9552 1.1 christos /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is 9553 1.7 christos the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the 9554 1.7 christos start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the 9555 1.7 christos low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */ 9556 1.7 christos /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a 9557 1.7 christos prescaled offset. */ 9558 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9559 1.1 christos plt_entry[4] | reloc_index, 9560 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16); 9561 1.1 christos /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is 9562 1.7 christos the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch 9563 1.7 christos instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry. 9564 1.7 christos The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value 9565 1.7 christos stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit 9566 1.1 christos offset. */ 9567 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, 9568 1.1 christos (plt_entry[5] 9569 1.1 christos | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)), 9570 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20); 9571 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6], 9572 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24); 9573 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7], 9574 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28); 9575 1.1 christos 9576 1.7 christos /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with 9577 1.7 christos the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction 9578 1.1 christos in this PLT entry. */ 9579 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma 9580 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset 9581 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 16), 9582 1.11 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset); 9583 1.11 christos 9584 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)) 9585 1.1 christos { 9586 1.1 christos /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */ 9587 1.7 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents 9588 1.7 christos + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index 9589 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS) 9590 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)); 9591 1.1 christos 9592 1.1 christos /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */ 9593 1.11 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma 9594 1.11 christos + plt->output_offset 9595 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 2); 9596 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, 9597 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_HA); 9598 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset; 9599 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc, 9600 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2)); 9601 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 9602 1.1 christos 9603 1.1 christos /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */ 9604 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma 9605 1.11 christos + plt->output_offset 9606 1.11 christos + ent->plt.offset + 6); 9607 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, 9608 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_LO); 9609 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset; 9610 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc, 9611 1.1 christos htab->srelplt2)); 9612 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 9613 1.1 christos 9614 1.7 christos /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this 9615 1.7 christos PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */ 9616 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma 9617 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset 9618 1.1 christos + got_offset); 9619 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, 9620 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR32); 9621 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16; 9622 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc, 9623 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2)); 9624 1.7 christos } 9625 1.7 christos 9626 1.7 christos /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT. 9627 1.7 christos In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the 9628 1.7 christos address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified 9629 1.7 christos by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of 9630 1.7 christos the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */ 9631 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma 9632 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset 9633 1.7 christos + got_offset); 9634 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0; 9635 1.7 christos } 9636 1.7 christos else 9637 1.7 christos { 9638 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0; 9639 1.1 christos if (!dyn) 9640 1.7 christos { 9641 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 9642 1.7 christos { 9643 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt; 9644 1.1 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt; 9645 1.1 christos } 9646 1.1 christos else 9647 1.7 christos { 9648 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal; 9649 1.7 christos relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL; 9650 1.7 christos } 9651 1.10 christos if (h->def_regular 9652 1.7 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 9653 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)) 9654 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h); 9655 1.7 christos } 9656 1.7 christos 9657 1.7 christos if (relplt == NULL) 9658 1.7 christos { 9659 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset; 9660 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc); 9661 1.7 christos } 9662 1.7 christos else 9663 1.7 christos { 9664 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma 9665 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset 9666 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset); 9667 1.7 christos 9668 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn) 9669 1.7 christos { 9670 1.10 christos /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic 9671 1.7 christos linker will fill it in. */ 9672 1.7 christos } 9673 1.7 christos else 9674 1.7 christos { 9675 1.7 christos bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset 9676 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma 9677 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset); 9678 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, 9679 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset); 9680 1.7 christos } 9681 1.1 christos } 9682 1.7 christos } 9683 1.7 christos 9684 1.7 christos if (relplt != NULL) 9685 1.7 christos { 9686 1.7 christos /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */ 9687 1.1 christos if (!dyn) 9688 1.11 christos { 9689 1.11 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 9690 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE); 9691 1.10 christos else 9692 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE); 9693 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++ 9694 1.10 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)); 9695 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 9696 1.1 christos } 9697 1.7 christos else 9698 1.7 christos { 9699 1.10 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT); 9700 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index 9701 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)); 9702 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h)) 9703 1.7 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 9704 1.7 christos } 9705 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, 9706 1.1 christos loc, relplt)); 9707 1.7 christos } 9708 1.7 christos doneone = true; 9709 1.1 christos } 9710 1.3 christos 9711 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn) 9712 1.1 christos { 9713 1.1 christos unsigned char *p; 9714 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt; 9715 1.1 christos 9716 1.1 christos if (!dyn) 9717 1.10 christos { 9718 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 9719 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt; 9720 1.7 christos else 9721 1.7 christos break; 9722 1.10 christos } 9723 1.7 christos 9724 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset; 9725 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info); 9726 1.7 christos 9727 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)) 9728 1.7 christos /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */ 9729 1.10 christos break; 9730 1.7 christos } 9731 1.7 christos else 9732 1.7 christos break; 9733 1.7 christos } 9734 1.7 christos return true; 9735 1.7 christos } 9736 1.7 christos 9737 1.7 christos /* Finish up PLT handling. */ 9738 1.7 christos 9739 1.7 christos bool 9740 1.7 christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info) 9741 1.7 christos { 9742 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 9743 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd; 9744 1.7 christos 9745 1.7 christos if (!htab) 9746 1.7 christos return true; 9747 1.7 christos 9748 1.7 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info); 9749 1.7 christos 9750 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next) 9751 1.7 christos { 9752 1.7 christos bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got; 9753 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt; 9754 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 9755 1.7 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount; 9756 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL; 9757 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 9758 1.7 christos 9759 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd)) 9760 1.7 christos continue; 9761 1.7 christos 9762 1.7 christos local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd); 9763 1.7 christos if (!local_got) 9764 1.7 christos continue; 9765 1.9 christos 9766 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd); 9767 1.7 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info; 9768 1.7 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount; 9769 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got; 9770 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount; 9771 1.7 christos for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt) 9772 1.10 christos for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 9773 1.7 christos { 9774 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1) 9775 1.7 christos { 9776 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 9777 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec; 9778 1.7 christos asection *plt, *relplt; 9779 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc; 9780 1.7 christos bfd_vma val; 9781 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela; 9782 1.7 christos unsigned char *p; 9783 1.7 christos 9784 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, 9785 1.7 christos lplt - local_plt, ibfd)) 9786 1.7 christos { 9787 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms) 9788 1.7 christos free (local_syms); 9789 1.7 christos return false; 9790 1.7 christos } 9791 1.7 christos 9792 1.7 christos val = sym->st_value; 9793 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL) 9794 1.7 christos val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma; 9795 1.7 christos 9796 1.7 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC) 9797 1.7 christos { 9798 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1; 9799 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt; 9800 1.7 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt; 9801 1.7 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE); 9802 1.7 christos } 9803 1.7 christos else 9804 1.7 christos { 9805 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal; 9806 1.11 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 9807 1.11 christos { 9808 1.7 christos relplt = htab->relpltlocal; 9809 1.9 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE); 9810 1.7 christos } 9811 1.7 christos else 9812 1.7 christos { 9813 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset; 9814 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc); 9815 1.7 christos continue; 9816 1.7 christos } 9817 1.7 christos } 9818 1.7 christos 9819 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset 9820 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset 9821 1.7 christos + plt->output_section->vma); 9822 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = val; 9823 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, 9824 1.7 christos relplt)); 9825 1.7 christos 9826 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset; 9827 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info); 9828 1.7 christos } 9829 1.10 christos } 9830 1.7 christos 9831 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL 9832 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms) 9833 1.7 christos { 9834 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory) 9835 1.7 christos free (local_syms); 9836 1.7 christos else 9837 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms; 9838 1.7 christos } 9839 1.7 christos } 9840 1.7 christos return true; 9841 1.7 christos } 9842 1.7 christos 9843 1.7 christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various 9844 1.7 christos dynamic sections here. */ 9845 1.7 christos 9846 1.7 christos static bool 9847 1.7 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd, 9848 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 9849 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 9850 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym) 9851 1.7 christos { 9852 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 9853 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent; 9854 1.7 christos 9855 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9856 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s", 9857 1.7 christos h->root.root.string); 9858 1.7 christos #endif 9859 1.7 christos 9860 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular 9861 1.7 christos || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info))) 9862 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next) 9863 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1) 9864 1.7 christos { 9865 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular) 9866 1.7 christos { 9867 1.7 christos /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as 9868 1.7 christos defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if 9869 1.7 christos there were any relocations where pointer equality 9870 1.7 christos matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to 9871 1.7 christos make function pointer comparisons work between an 9872 1.7 christos application and shared library), otherwise set it 9873 1.7 christos to zero. */ 9874 1.7 christos sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF; 9875 1.7 christos if (!h->pointer_equality_needed) 9876 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0; 9877 1.7 christos else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak) 9878 1.7 christos { 9879 1.7 christos /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but 9880 1.7 christos that is better than breaking tests for a NULL 9881 1.7 christos function pointer. */ 9882 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0; 9883 1.7 christos } 9884 1.7 christos } 9885 1.7 christos else 9886 1.1 christos { 9887 1.1 christos /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie 9888 1.1 christos executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid 9889 1.1 christos text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in 9890 1.1 christos allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic 9891 1.1 christos function symbols with plt entries, because we need 9892 1.1 christos to keep the original value around for the ifunc 9893 1.1 christos relocation. */ 9894 1.1 christos sym->st_shndx 9895 1.1 christos = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section 9896 1.1 christos (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section)); 9897 1.1 christos sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset 9898 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset 9899 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma); 9900 1.1 christos } 9901 1.1 christos break; 9902 1.7 christos } 9903 1.7 christos 9904 1.1 christos if (h->needs_copy) 9905 1.7 christos { 9906 1.1 christos asection *s; 9907 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela; 9908 1.1 christos 9909 1.1 christos /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */ 9910 1.1 christos 9911 1.11 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9912 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, ", copy"); 9913 1.1 christos #endif 9914 1.1 christos 9915 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1); 9916 1.1 christos 9917 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs) 9918 1.10 christos s = htab->relsbss; 9919 1.1 christos else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro) 9920 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro; 9921 1.1 christos else 9922 1.3 christos s = htab->elf.srelbss; 9923 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 9924 1.3 christos 9925 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h); 9926 1.3 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY); 9927 1.3 christos rela.r_addend = 0; 9928 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, s)); 9929 1.3 christos } 9930 1.3 christos 9931 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9932 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n"); 9933 1.1 christos #endif 9934 1.1 christos 9935 1.1 christos return true; 9936 1.1 christos } 9937 1.1 christos 9938 1.1 christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class 9940 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info, 9941 1.1 christos const asection *rel_sec, 9942 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela) 9943 1.1 christos { 9944 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 9945 1.1 christos 9946 1.10 christos if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt) 9947 1.1 christos return reloc_class_ifunc; 9948 1.1 christos 9949 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info)) 9950 1.1 christos { 9951 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE: 9952 1.1 christos return reloc_class_relative; 9953 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT: 9954 1.10 christos return reloc_class_plt; 9955 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY: 9956 1.1 christos return reloc_class_copy; 9957 1.1 christos default: 9958 1.1 christos return reloc_class_normal; 9959 1.1 christos } 9960 1.1 christos } 9961 1.7 christos 9962 1.1 christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */ 9964 1.1 christos 9965 1.1 christos static bool 9966 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd, 9967 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info) 9968 1.1 christos { 9969 1.1 christos asection *sdyn; 9970 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab; 9971 1.1 christos bfd_vma got; 9972 1.7 christos bfd *dynobj; 9973 1.1 christos bool ret = true; 9974 1.1 christos 9975 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG 9976 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n"); 9977 1.1 christos #endif 9978 1.1 christos 9979 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info); 9980 1.1 christos dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj; 9981 1.1 christos sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic"); 9982 1.1 christos 9983 1.1 christos got = 0; 9984 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL) 9985 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot); 9986 1.10 christos 9987 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 9988 1.1 christos { 9989 1.7 christos Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend; 9990 1.1 christos 9991 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL); 9992 1.1 christos 9993 1.1 christos dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents; 9994 1.7 christos dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size); 9995 1.1 christos for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++) 9996 1.1 christos { 9997 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn; 9998 1.7 christos asection *s; 9999 1.1 christos 10000 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn); 10001 1.1 christos 10002 1.1 christos switch (dyn.d_tag) 10003 1.1 christos { 10004 1.1 christos case DT_PLTGOT: 10005 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks) 10006 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sgotplt; 10007 1.7 christos else 10008 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt; 10009 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset; 10010 1.7 christos break; 10011 1.7 christos 10012 1.7 christos case DT_PLTRELSZ: 10013 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size; 10014 1.7 christos break; 10015 1.1 christos 10016 1.1 christos case DT_JMPREL: 10017 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelplt; 10018 1.10 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset; 10019 1.1 christos break; 10020 1.1 christos 10021 1.1 christos case DT_PPC_GOT: 10022 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got; 10023 1.1 christos break; 10024 1.1 christos 10025 1.1 christos case DT_TEXTREL: 10026 1.1 christos if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver) 10027 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo 10028 1.7 christos (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect " 10029 1.7 christos "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n")); 10030 1.1 christos else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver) 10031 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo 10032 1.7 christos (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect " 10033 1.1 christos "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n")); 10034 1.1 christos continue; 10035 1.1 christos 10036 1.1 christos default: 10037 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks 10038 1.1 christos && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn)) 10039 1.1 christos break; 10040 1.1 christos continue; 10041 1.1 christos } 10042 1.1 christos 10043 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon); 10044 1.1 christos } 10045 1.1 christos } 10046 1.1 christos 10047 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL 10048 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr) 10049 1.1 christos { 10050 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot 10051 1.1 christos || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt) 10052 1.1 christos { 10053 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents; 10054 1.1 christos 10055 1.1 christos p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value; 10056 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD) 10057 1.7 christos { 10058 1.7 christos /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4 10059 1.7 christos so that a function can easily find the address of 10060 1.7 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */ 10061 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4 10062 1.1 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size); 10063 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4); 10064 1.1 christos } 10065 1.1 christos 10066 1.7 christos if (sdyn != NULL) 10067 1.1 christos { 10068 1.1 christos bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset; 10069 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value 10070 1.10 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size); 10071 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p); 10072 1.7 christos } 10073 1.7 christos } 10074 1.1 christos else 10075 1.7 christos { 10076 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */ 10077 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"), 10078 1.1 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string, 10079 1.1 christos (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL 10080 1.1 christos ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot)); 10081 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 10082 1.1 christos ret = false; 10083 1.1 christos } 10084 1.1 christos 10085 1.1 christos elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4; 10086 1.1 christos } 10087 1.1 christos 10088 1.1 christos /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */ 10089 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks 10090 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL 10091 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->size != 0 10092 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr) 10093 1.1 christos { 10094 1.1 christos asection *splt = htab->elf.splt; 10095 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */ 10096 1.1 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info) 10097 1.1 christos ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry 10098 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry); 10099 1.1 christos 10100 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)) 10101 1.1 christos { 10102 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot); 10103 1.1 christos 10104 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value), 10105 1.1 christos splt->contents + 0); 10106 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value), 10107 1.1 christos splt->contents + 4); 10108 1.1 christos } 10109 1.1 christos else 10110 1.7 christos { 10111 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0); 10112 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4); 10113 1.1 christos } 10114 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8); 10115 1.11 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12); 10116 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16); 10117 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20); 10118 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24); 10119 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28); 10120 1.7 christos 10121 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)) 10122 1.1 christos { 10123 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela; 10124 1.11 christos bfd_byte *loc; 10125 1.1 christos 10126 1.1 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents; 10127 1.1 christos 10128 1.1 christos /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */ 10129 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma 10130 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset 10131 1.1 christos + 2); 10132 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA); 10133 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0; 10134 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2)); 10135 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 10136 1.1 christos 10137 1.1 christos /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */ 10138 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma 10139 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset 10140 1.1 christos + 6); 10141 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO); 10142 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0; 10143 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2)); 10144 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 10145 1.1 christos 10146 1.1 christos /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong 10147 1.1 christos symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order 10148 1.1 christos in which symbols were output. */ 10149 1.1 christos while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size) 10150 1.1 christos { 10151 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rel; 10152 1.1 christos 10153 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel); 10154 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA); 10155 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc); 10156 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 10157 1.1 christos 10158 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel); 10159 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO); 10160 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc); 10161 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 10162 1.1 christos 10163 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel); 10164 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32); 10165 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc); 10166 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela); 10167 1.1 christos } 10168 1.1 christos } 10169 1.1 christos } 10170 1.1 christos 10171 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL 10172 1.1 christos && htab->glink->contents != NULL 10173 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created) 10174 1.1 christos { 10175 1.1 christos unsigned char *p; 10176 1.1 christos unsigned char *endp; 10177 1.1 christos bfd_vma res0; 10178 1.1 christos 10179 1.1 christos /* 10180 1.1 christos * PIC glink code is the following: 10181 1.1 christos * 10182 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub. 10183 1.1 christos * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha 10184 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11) 10185 1.1 christos * mtctr 11 10186 1.1 christos * bctr 10187 1.7 christos * 10188 1.1 christos * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry. 10189 1.7 christos * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these 10190 1.7 christos * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4. 10191 1.1 christos * res_0: b PLTresolve 10192 1.1 christos * res_1: b PLTresolve 10193 1.7 christos * . 10194 1.1 christos * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops 10195 1.7 christos * res_n_m3: nop 10196 1.1 christos * res_n_m2: nop 10197 1.1 christos * res_n_m1: 10198 1.1 christos * 10199 1.1 christos * PLTresolve: 10200 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha 10201 1.1 christos * mflr 0 10202 1.1 christos * bcl 20,31,1f 10203 1.1 christos * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l 10204 1.1 christos * mflr 12 10205 1.1 christos * mtlr 0 10206 1.1 christos * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4 10207 1.1 christos * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha 10208 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve 10209 1.7 christos * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address 10210 1.7 christos * mtctr 0 10211 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11 10212 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset. 10213 1.7 christos * bctr 10214 1.7 christos * 10215 1.1 christos * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler. 10216 1.1 christos * 10217 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub. 10218 1.1 christos * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha 10219 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11) 10220 1.1 christos * mtctr 11 10221 1.1 christos * bctr 10222 1.1 christos * 10223 1.1 christos * The branch table is the same, then comes 10224 1.3 christos * 10225 1.1 christos * PLTresolve: 10226 1.1 christos * lis 12,(got+4)@ha 10227 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha 10228 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve 10229 1.1 christos * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4 10230 1.1 christos * mtctr 0 10231 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11 10232 1.1 christos * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address 10233 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset. 10234 1.1 christos * bctr 10235 1.1 christos */ 10236 1.1 christos 10237 1.1 christos /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one), 10238 1.1 christos and perhaps some padding. */ 10239 1.3 christos p = htab->glink->contents; 10240 1.3 christos p += htab->glink_pltresolve; 10241 1.3 christos endp = htab->glink->contents; 10242 1.3 christos endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE; 10243 1.3 christos while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4)) 10244 1.3 christos { 10245 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p); 10246 1.3 christos p += 4; 10247 1.3 christos } 10248 1.3 christos while (p < endp) 10249 1.3 christos { 10250 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p); 10251 1.3 christos p += 4; 10252 1.3 christos } 10253 1.3 christos 10254 1.3 christos res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve 10255 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma 10256 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset); 10257 1.3 christos 10258 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround) 10259 1.3 christos { 10260 1.3 christos /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't 10261 1.3 christos result in prefetch over the end of the page into the 10262 1.3 christos glink branch table. */ 10263 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2; 10264 1.3 christos bfd_vma page_addr; 10265 1.3 christos bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma 10266 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset); 10267 1.3 christos 10268 1.3 christos for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize; 10269 1.3 christos page_addr > glink_start; 10270 1.3 christos page_addr -= pagesize) 10271 1.3 christos { 10272 1.1 christos /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */ 10273 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc; 10274 1.3 christos unsigned int insn; 10275 1.1 christos 10276 1.1 christos loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start; 10277 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc); 10278 1.1 christos if (insn == BCTR) 10279 1.1 christos { 10280 1.1 christos /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least 10281 1.1 christos one other call stub before this one. */ 10282 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16); 10283 1.7 christos if (insn == BCTR) 10284 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc); 10285 1.7 christos else 10286 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc); 10287 1.7 christos } 10288 1.7 christos } 10289 1.7 christos } 10290 1.7 christos 10291 1.7 christos /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */ 10292 1.7 christos endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE; 10293 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)) 10294 1.7 christos { 10295 1.7 christos bfd_vma bcl; 10296 1.7 christos 10297 1.7 christos bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4 10298 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma 10299 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset); 10300 1.7 christos 10301 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p); 10302 1.7 christos p += 4; 10303 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p); 10304 1.1 christos p += 4; 10305 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p); 10306 1.1 christos p += 4; 10307 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p); 10308 1.7 christos p += 4; 10309 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p); 10310 1.7 christos p += 4; 10311 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p); 10312 1.7 christos p += 4; 10313 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p); 10314 1.7 christos p += 4; 10315 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p); 10316 1.1 christos p += 4; 10317 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl)) 10318 1.7 christos { 10319 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p); 10320 1.7 christos p += 4; 10321 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p); 10322 1.7 christos p += 4; 10323 1.7 christos } 10324 1.7 christos else 10325 1.7 christos { 10326 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p); 10327 1.7 christos p += 4; 10328 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p); 10329 1.7 christos p += 4; 10330 1.7 christos } 10331 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p); 10332 1.7 christos p += 4; 10333 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p); 10334 1.7 christos } 10335 1.1 christos else 10336 1.7 christos { 10337 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p); 10338 1.7 christos p += 4; 10339 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p); 10340 1.7 christos p += 4; 10341 1.7 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8)) 10342 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p); 10343 1.7 christos else 10344 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p); 10345 1.7 christos p += 4; 10346 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p); 10347 1.7 christos p += 4; 10348 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p); 10349 1.7 christos p += 4; 10350 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p); 10351 1.1 christos p += 4; 10352 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8)) 10353 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p); 10354 1.1 christos else 10355 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p); 10356 1.1 christos } 10357 1.1 christos p += 4; 10358 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p); 10359 1.1 christos p += 4; 10360 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p); 10361 1.1 christos p += 4; 10362 1.1 christos while (p < endp) 10363 1.1 christos { 10364 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 10365 1.1 christos htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p); 10366 1.1 christos p += 4; 10367 1.1 christos } 10368 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (p == endp); 10369 1.1 christos } 10370 1.1 christos 10371 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL 10372 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL) 10373 1.1 christos { 10374 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents; 10375 1.10 christos bfd_vma val; 10376 1.1 christos 10377 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie); 10378 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */ 10379 1.1 christos p += 4; 10380 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */ 10381 1.3 christos p += 4; 10382 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. */ 10383 1.3 christos val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma 10384 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset); 10385 1.1 christos val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma 10386 1.1 christos + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset); 10387 1.1 christos val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents; 10388 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p); 10389 1.3 christos 10390 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME 10391 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info, 10392 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame, 10393 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame->contents)) 10394 1.1 christos return false; 10395 1.1 christos } 10396 1.1 christos 10397 1.1 christos return ret; 10398 1.1 christos } 10399 1.1 christos 10400 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec 10402 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle" 10403 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec 10404 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc" 10405 1.3 christos #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc 10406 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA 10407 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC 10408 1.1 christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000 10409 1.1 christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000 10410 1.1 christos #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto 10411 1.1 christos 10412 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC 10413 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC 10414 1.1 christos #endif 10415 1.1 christos 10416 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD 10417 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD 10418 1.1 christos #endif 10419 1.1 christos 10420 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1 10421 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1 10422 1.7 christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1 10423 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1 10424 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1 10425 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1 10426 1.12 christos 10427 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject 10428 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data 10429 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section 10430 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup 10431 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup 10432 1.7 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags 10433 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create 10434 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab 10435 1.1 christos 10436 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p 10437 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook 10438 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr 10439 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section 10440 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections 10441 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs 10442 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible 10443 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol 10444 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol 10445 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook 10446 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_late_size_sections ppc_elf_late_size_sections 10447 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol 10448 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol 10449 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections 10450 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections 10451 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers 10452 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map 10453 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus 10454 1.3 christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo 10455 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note 10456 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class 10457 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing 10458 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing 10459 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section 10460 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr 10461 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val 10462 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded 10463 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section 10464 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags 10465 1.1 christos 10466 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h" 10467 1.1 christos 10468 1.1 christos /* FreeBSD Target */ 10469 1.1 christos 10470 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM 10471 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME 10472 1.3 christos 10473 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM 10474 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec 10475 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME 10476 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd" 10477 1.1 christos 10478 1.10 christos #undef ELF_OSABI 10479 1.10 christos #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD 10480 1.10 christos 10481 1.1 christos #undef elf32_bed 10482 1.1 christos #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed 10483 1.7 christos 10484 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h" 10485 1.1 christos 10486 1.1 christos /* VxWorks Target */ 10487 1.1 christos 10488 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM 10489 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME 10490 1.1 christos 10491 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM 10492 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec 10493 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME 10494 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks" 10495 1.1 christos 10496 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI 10497 1.1 christos 10498 1.1 christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS 10499 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks 10500 1.1 christos 10501 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */ 10502 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * 10503 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec) 10504 1.1 christos { 10505 1.7 christos if (sec->name == NULL) 10506 1.1 christos return NULL; 10507 1.1 christos 10508 1.1 christos if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0) 10509 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec); 10510 1.1 christos 10511 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec); 10512 1.1 christos } 10513 1.1 christos 10514 1.1 christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides 10515 1.10 christos appropriately for VxWorks. */ 10516 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table * 10517 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd) 10518 1.1 christos { 10519 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret; 10520 1.7 christos 10521 1.1 christos ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd); 10522 1.1 christos if (ret) 10523 1.1 christos { 10524 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab 10525 1.7 christos = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret; 10526 1.10 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS; 10527 1.1 christos htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE; 10528 1.7 christos htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE; 10529 1.1 christos htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE; 10530 1.1 christos } 10531 1.10 christos return ret; 10532 1.9 christos } 10533 1.1 christos 10534 1.9 christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */ 10535 1.9 christos static bool 10536 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, 10537 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info, 10538 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, 10539 1.1 christos const char **namep, 10540 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp, 10541 1.1 christos asection **secp, 10542 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp) 10543 1.1 christos { 10544 1.1 christos if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, 10545 1.1 christos valp)) 10546 1.1 christos return false; 10547 1.1 christos 10548 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp); 10549 1.1 christos } 10550 1.1 christos 10551 1.1 christos static bool 10552 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd) 10553 1.7 christos { 10554 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd); 10555 1.1 christos return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd); 10556 1.1 christos } 10557 1.1 christos 10558 1.1 christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so 10559 1.1 christos define it. */ 10560 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym 10561 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1 10562 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt 10563 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1 10564 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 10565 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0 10566 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 10567 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0 10568 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly 10569 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1 10570 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size 10571 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12 10572 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 10573 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1 10574 1.1 christos 10575 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab 10576 1.1 christos 10577 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create 10578 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \ 10579 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create 10580 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook 10581 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \ 10582 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook 10583 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook 10584 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \ 10585 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook 10586 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing 10587 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \ 10588 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing 10589 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr 10590 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \ 10591 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr 10592 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs 10593 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \ 10594 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs 10595 10596 #undef elf32_bed 10597 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed 10598 10599 #include "elf32-target.h" 10600